blob: d8b246fb5de84710ab6ef5e9663bc947b6a9aee2 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Amaury Denoyelled4759ba2021-04-12 11:12:24 +02007 2021/04/12
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194
1951.2. HTTP request
196-----------------
197
198First, let's consider this HTTP request :
199
200 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100201 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
203 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
204 3 User-agent: my small browser
205 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
206 5 Accept: image/png
207
208
2091.2.1. The Request line
210-----------------------
211
212Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
213
214 - a METHOD : GET
215 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
216 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
217
218All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
219which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
220followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
221is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
222desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
223the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
224
225The URI itself can have several forms :
226
227 - A "relative URI" :
228
229 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
230
231 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
232 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
233
234 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
235
236 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
237
238 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
239 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
240 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
241 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
242 must accept this form too.
243
244 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
245 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
246 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200248 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
249 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
250 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
251 other protocols too.
252
253In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
254mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
255on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
256It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
257specific to the language, framework or application in use.
258
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100259HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100260assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200262
2631.2.2. The request headers
264--------------------------
265
266The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
267beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
268an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
269Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
270values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
271encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
272the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
273define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200276their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau371ab182020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200278as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
279normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
280representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
281HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
283The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
284that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
285is one valid form of empty line.
286
287Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
288headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
289about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
290application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
291
292Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000293 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
295 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
296 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
297
298
2991.3. HTTP response
300------------------
301
302An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
303messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
304
305 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100306 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
308 2 Content-length: 350
309 3 Content-Type: text/html
310
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200311As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
312codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
313response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100314continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
315the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
316following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
317sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
318(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
319correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
320such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
321state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
322over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
323if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
324information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003271.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200328------------------------
329
330Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
331
332 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
333 - a status code : 200
334 - a reason : OK
335
336The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100337 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
338 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
339 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
340 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
341 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000343Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100344"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
346messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
347or "Authentication Required".
348
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350
351 Code When / reason
352 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
353 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
354 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
355 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100356 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
357 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358 400 for an invalid or too large request
359 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
360 accessing the stats page)
361 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
Florian Tham9f3bda02020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100362 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Thamc09f7972020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100364 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
365 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
367 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
368 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
369 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
370 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
371 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
372 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
373
374The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3754.2).
376
377
3781.3.2. The response headers
379---------------------------
380
381Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
382the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
383details.
384
385
3862. Configuring HAProxy
387----------------------
388
3892.1. Configuration file format
390------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200391
392HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
393
394 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
395 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
396 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
397 "frontend" and "backend".
398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100399The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
400referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200401delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200403
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004042.2. Quoting and escaping
405-------------------------
406
407HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
408many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
409with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
410single quotes.
411
412If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
413them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
414escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
415
416Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
417
418 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
419 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
420 \\ to use a backslash
421 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
422 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
423
424Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
425the interpretation of:
426
427 space as a parameter separator
428 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
429 # hash as a comment start
430
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200431Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
432-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
433backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
434
435Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200436quoting.
437
438Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
439nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
440
441Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
442equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
443
444 Example:
445 # those are equivalents:
446 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
447 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
448 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
451
452 # those are equivalents:
453 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
454 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
455 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
457
458
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004592.3. Environment variables
460--------------------------
461
462HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
463interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
464configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
465optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
466shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
467underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
468
469 Example:
470
471 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
472
473 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
474
475 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
476
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200477Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
478file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
481 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
482
483* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
484 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
485 directory.
486
487* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
488
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500489* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200490 processes, separated by semicolons.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 CLI, separated by semicolons.
494
495See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200496
4972.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200498----------------
499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100500Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100501values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
502otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
503numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
504for every keyword. Supported units are :
505
506 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
507 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
508 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
509 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
510 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
511 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
512
513
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005142.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200515-------------
516
517 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
518 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
519 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
520 global
521 daemon
522 maxconn 256
523
524 defaults
525 mode http
526 timeout connect 5000ms
527 timeout client 50000ms
528 timeout server 50000ms
529
530 frontend http-in
531 bind *:80
532 default_backend servers
533
534 backend servers
535 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
536
537
538 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
539 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
540 global
541 daemon
542 maxconn 256
543
544 defaults
545 mode http
546 timeout connect 5000ms
547 timeout client 50000ms
548 timeout server 50000ms
549
550 listen http-in
551 bind *:80
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
556
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100557 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200558
559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005603. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561--------------------
562
563Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
564are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
565of them have command-line equivalents.
566
567The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
568
569 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200570 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200572 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - description
576 - deviceatlas-json-file
577 - deviceatlas-log-level
578 - deviceatlas-separator
579 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900580 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200581 - gid
582 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100583 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200584 - h1-case-adjust
585 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100588 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200590 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200592 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200593 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - presetenv
596 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - uid
598 - ulimit-n
599 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200600 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100601 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200602 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200603 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200604 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - ssl-default-bind-options
606 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-server-options
609 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100610 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100611 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100613 - 51degrees-data-file
614 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200615 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200616 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200617 - wurfl-data-file
618 - wurfl-information-list
619 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100621
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200622 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200623 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200625 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100626 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100627 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100628 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200629 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200630 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200631 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200632 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633 - noepoll
634 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000635 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100637 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300638 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000639 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100640 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200641 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200642 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200643 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000644 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000645 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200646 - tune.buffers.limit
647 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200649 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100650 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200651 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200652 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200653 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100654 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200655 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200656 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100657 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100658 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100659 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100660 - tune.lua.session-timeout
661 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200662 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100663 - tune.maxaccept
664 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200665 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200666 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200667 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua5e11c02020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200668 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
669 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100670 - tune.rcvbuf.client
671 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100672 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200673 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100674 - tune.sndbuf.client
675 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100676 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100677 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200678 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100679 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200680 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200681 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100682 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200683 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100684 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200685 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
686 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
687 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100688 - tune.zlib.memlevel
689 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100690
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691 * Debugging
692 - debug
693 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694
695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006963.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697------------------------------------
698
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200699ca-base <dir>
700 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200701 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
702 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704chroot <jail dir>
705 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
706 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
707 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
708 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
709 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100711
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
713 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
714 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
715 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
716 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
717 set. These sets have the format
718
719 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
720
721 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100722 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100723 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
724 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100725 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
726 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100727 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100728 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100730 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100731 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
732 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
733 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
734 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100735
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100736 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
737 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
738 on the machine's word size.
739
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
742 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
743 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
744 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
745 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
746 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100747
748 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
750
751 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
752 # first 4 CPUs
753
754 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
755 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
756 # word size.
757
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100760 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
763
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100764 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
765 # and so on.
766 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100770 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
772 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
773 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
774
775 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
776 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
777 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
778
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100779 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
780 # and a thread range.
781 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
782 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
784
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200785crt-base <dir>
786 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
787 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
788 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
789
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790daemon
791 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
792 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100793 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
794 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200796deviceatlas-json-file <path>
797 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100798 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200799
800deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100801 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200802 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
803
804deviceatlas-separator <char>
805 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
806 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
807
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100808deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200809 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
810 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
811 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100812
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900813external-check
814 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
815 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
816 See "option external-check".
817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818gid <number>
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700819 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
821 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100822 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
823 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100825
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100826group <group name>
827 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
828 See also "gid" and "user".
829
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100830hard-stop-after <time>
831 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
832
833 Arguments :
834 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
835 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
836 SIGUSR1 signal.
837
838 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
839 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
840 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
841
842 Example:
843 global
844 hard-stop-after 30s
845
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200846h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
847 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
848 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
849 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
850 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500851 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200852 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
853 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
854 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
855 specified in a proxy.
856
857 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
858 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
859 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
860 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
861 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
862 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
863 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
864
865 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
866 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
867 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
868 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
869 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
870
871 Example:
872 global
873 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
874
875 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
876 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
877
878h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
879 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
880 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
881 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
882 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
883 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
884 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
885 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
886 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
887
888 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
889 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
890 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
891
892 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
893 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
894
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200895log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
896 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100897 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100898 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100899 configured with "log global".
900
901 <address> can be one of:
902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100903 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100904 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
905 port).
906
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100907 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
908 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
909 port).
910
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100911 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100912 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
913 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100914 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100915
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100916 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
917 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
918 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
919 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
920 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
921 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
922 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
923 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
924 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
925 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
926 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
927 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
928 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
929 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100930 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
931 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100932
933 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
934 "fd@2", see above.
935
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200936 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
937 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100938
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200939 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
940 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
941 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
942 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
943 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
944 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
945 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
946 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
947 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
948 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100949 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
950 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200951
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200952 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
953 one of the following :
954
955 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
956 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
957
958 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
959 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
960
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100961 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
962 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
963 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
964 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
965 logger consumes.
966
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100967 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
968 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
969 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
970 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
971
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200972 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
973 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
974 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
975 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
976 set with <sample_size> parameter.
977
978 <sample_size>
979 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
980 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
981 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
982 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
983 (see also <ranges> parameter).
984
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100985 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200986
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100987 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
988 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
989 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
990
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100991 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
992 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
993 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
994 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995
996 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200997 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
998 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
999 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1000 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1001 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1002 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001004 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001006log-send-hostname [<string>]
1007 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1008 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1009 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1010 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1011 the logs.
1012
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001013log-tag <string>
1014 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1015 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1016 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001017 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001018
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001019lua-load <file>
1020 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1021 used multiple times.
1022
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001023master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001024 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1025 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1026 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001027 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001028 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1029 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001030 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1031 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1032 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1033 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1034 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001035
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001036 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001037
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001038mworker-max-reloads <number>
1039 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001040 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001041 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1042 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1043 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1044
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001045nbproc <number>
1046 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1047 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1048 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001049 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1050 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001051 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1052 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001053
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001054nbthread <number>
1055 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001056 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1057 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1058 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1059 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1060 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001061 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1062 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1063 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1064 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1065 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1066 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1067 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001068
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001070 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001071 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1072 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1073
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001074presetenv <name> <value>
1075 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1076 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1077 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1078 and "unsetenv".
1079
1080resetenv [<name> ...]
1081 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1082 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1083 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1084 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1085 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1086 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1087 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1088 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1089
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001090stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001091 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1092 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1093 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1094 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1095 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1096 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001097 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001098 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1099 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1100 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1101 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001102
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001103server-state-base <directory>
1104 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001105 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1106 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001107
1108server-state-file <file>
1109 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1110 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1111 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1112 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1113 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1114 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1115 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1116 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001117 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1118 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001119
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001120setenv <name> <value>
1121 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1122 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1123 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1124 and "unsetenv".
1125
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001126set-dumpable
1127 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1128 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1129 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1130 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1131 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1132 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1133 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1134 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1135 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1136 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1137 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1138 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1139 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1140 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1141 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1142 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1143 expected when dying.
1144
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001145ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1147 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001148 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001149 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001150 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1151 information and recommendations see e.g.
1152 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1153 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1154 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1155 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001156
1157ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1159 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1160 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1161 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1162 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001163 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1164 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1165 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001166 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001167
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001168ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1170 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1171 keyword to see available options.
1172
1173 Example:
1174 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001175 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001176
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001177ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1179 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001180 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001181 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001182 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1183 information and recommendations see e.g.
1184 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1185 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1186 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1187 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1188 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001189
1190ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1192 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1193 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1194 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1195 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001196 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1197 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1198 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1199 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001200
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001201ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1203 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1204 keyword to see available options.
1205
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001206ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1208 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1209 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001210 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001211 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001212 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1213 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1214 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1215 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001216 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1217 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1218 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1219
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001220ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1221 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1222 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1223 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1224
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001225stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1226 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1227 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1228 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001229 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001230 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001231
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001232 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1233 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1234 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001235
1236stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1237 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1238 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001239 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001240
1241stats maxconn <connections>
1242 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1243 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1244
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001245uid <number>
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001246 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001247 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1248 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1249 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1250
1251ulimit-n <number>
1252 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1253 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1254 option.
1255
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001256unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1257 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1258
1259 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1260 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1261 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1262 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1263 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1264 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1265 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1266 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1267 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1268 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1269
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001270unsetenv [<name> ...]
1271 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1272 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1273 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1274 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1275 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1276 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1277 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1278
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001279user <user name>
1280 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1281 See also "uid" and "group".
1282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001283node <name>
1284 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1285
1286 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1287 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1288 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1289 traffic.
1290
1291description <text>
1292 Add a text that describes the instance.
1293
1294 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1295 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1296 "<" and ">" characters.
1297
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100129851degrees-data-file <file path>
1299 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001300 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001301
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001302 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001303 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1304
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001306 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1307 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1308 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1309
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001310 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001311 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1312
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001314 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1315 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1316
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001317 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1318 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1319
132051degrees-cache-size <number>
1321 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1322 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1323 By default, this cache is disabled.
1324
1325 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001326 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1327
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001328wurfl-data-file <file path>
1329 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1330 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1331
1332 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1333 with USE_WURFL=1.
1334
1335wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1336 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1337 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1338 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1339
1340 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1341
1342 Valid WURFL properties are:
1343 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1344
1345 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1346 device.
1347
1348 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1349 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1350
1351 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1352 particular web request.
1353
1354 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1355 used Libwurfl API version.
1356
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001357 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1358 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1359
1360 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1361 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1362
1363 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1364
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001365 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1366 with USE_WURFL=1.
1367
1368wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1369 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1370 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1371
1372 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1373 with USE_WURFL=1.
1374
1375wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1376 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1377 thus before the chroot.
1378
1379 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1380 with USE_WURFL=1.
1381
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001382wurfl-cache-size <size>
1383 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1384 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001385 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001386 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001387
1388 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1389 with USE_WURFL=1.
1390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013913.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001392-----------------------
1393
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001394busy-polling
1395 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1396 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1397 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1398 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1399 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1400 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1401 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1402 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1403 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1404 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1405 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1406 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1407 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1408 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1409 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1410 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1411 "poll" pollers.
1412
William Dauchy857b9432019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001413 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1414 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1415 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1416
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001417max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1418 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1419 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1420 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1421 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1422 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1423 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1424 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1425 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001427maxconn <number>
1428 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1429 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1430 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001431 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1432 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1433 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1434 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001435 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1436 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1437 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1438 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1439 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1440 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001442maxconnrate <number>
1443 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1444 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1445 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1446 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1447 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1448 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1449 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1450 fairness.
1451
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001452maxcomprate <number>
1453 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001454 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001455 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1456 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1457 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001458 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001459 default value.
1460
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001461maxcompcpuusage <number>
1462 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1463 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1464 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1465 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1466 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1467 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1468 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1469 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1470
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001471maxpipes <number>
1472 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1473 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1474 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1475 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1476 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1477 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1478
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001479maxsessrate <number>
1480 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1481 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1482 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1483 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1484 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1485 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1486 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1487 fairness.
1488
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001489maxsslconn <number>
1490 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1491 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1492 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1493 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1494 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1495 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1496 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001497 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1498 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1499 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1500 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1501 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1502 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1503 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001504
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001505maxsslrate <number>
1506 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1507 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1508 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1509 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1510 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1511 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1512 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1513 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1514 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1515 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1516
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001517maxzlibmem <number>
1518 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1519 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1520 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001521 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1522 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1523 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1524
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001525noepoll
1526 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1527 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001528 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001529
1530nokqueue
1531 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1532 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1533 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1534
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001535noevports
1536 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1537 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1538 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1539 also "nopoll".
1540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001541nopoll
1542 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1543 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001544 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001545 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1546 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001547
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001548nosplice
1549 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001550 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001551 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001552 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001553 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1554 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1555 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1556 "option splice-response".
1557
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001558nogetaddrinfo
1559 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1560 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1561
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001562noreuseport
1563 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1564 command line argument "-dR".
1565
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001566profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1567 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1568 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1569 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1570 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001571 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001572 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1573 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1574 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1575 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1576
1577 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1578 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1579 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1580 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1581 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001582 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1583 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1584 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1585 CLI.
1586
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001587spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001588 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1589 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1590 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1591 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1592 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1593 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001594
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001595ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001596 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001597 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001598 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1599 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1600 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1601 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1602 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001603 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1604 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001605 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1606 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1607 openssl configuration file uses:
1608 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1609
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001610ssl-mode-async
1611 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001612 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001613 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1614 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1615 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001616 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001617 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001618
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001619tune.buffers.limit <number>
1620 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1621 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1622 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1623 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1624 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001625 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001626 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1627 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1628 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1629 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1630 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1631 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1632 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1633 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1634 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1635
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001636tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1637 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1638 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1639 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1640 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1641
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001642tune.bufsize <number>
1643 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1644 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1645 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1646 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1647 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1648 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1649 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001650 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1651 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1652 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001653 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001654 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1655 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1656 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001657
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001658tune.chksize <number>
1659 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1660 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1661 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1662 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1663 checks whenever possible.
1664
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001665tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1666 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1667 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1668 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1669 this value. The default value is 1.
1670
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001671tune.fail-alloc
1672 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1673 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1674 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1675 gracefully.
1676
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001677tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1678 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1679 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1680 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1681 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1682 change it.
1683
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001684tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1685 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001686 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1687 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001688 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1689 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1690 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1691 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1692 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1693
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001694tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1695 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1696 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1697 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1698 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1699 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1700 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1701 recommended not to change this value.
1702
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001703tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1704 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1705 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1706 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1707 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1708 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1709 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1710 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1711
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001712tune.http.cookielen <number>
1713 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1714 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1715 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1716 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1717 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1718 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1719 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1720 to change this value.
1721
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001722tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001723 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1724 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001725 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001727 configuration directives too.
1728 The default value is 1024.
1729
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001730tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1731 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1732 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1733 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1734 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1735 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1736 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001737 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1738 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1739 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001740
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001741tune.idletimer <timeout>
1742 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1743 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1744 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1745 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1746 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1747 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001748 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001749 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001750 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1751
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001752tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1753 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1754 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1755 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1756 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1757 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1758 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1759 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1760 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1761 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1762
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001763tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1764 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001765 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001766 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1767 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001768 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001769 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1770 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1771
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001772tune.lua.maxmem
1773 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1774 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1775 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1776 memory.
1777
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001778tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1779 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001780 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1781 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001782 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001783
1784tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1785 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1786 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1787 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1788 check servers.
1789
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001790tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1791 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1792 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1793 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001795
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001796tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001797 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1798 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1799 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1800 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1801 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1802 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1803 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1804 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1805 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1806 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001807
1808tune.maxpollevents <number>
1809 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1810 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1811 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1812 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1813 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1814
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001815tune.maxrewrite <number>
1816 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1817 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1818 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1819 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1820 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1821 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1822 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1823 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1824 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1825 bufsize.
1826
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001827tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1828 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1829 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1830 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1831 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1832 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1833 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1834 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1835 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1836 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001837 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1838 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001839 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1840 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1841 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1842 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1843 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1844 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1845 setting this parameter to 0.
1846
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001847tune.pipesize <number>
1848 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1849 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1850 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1851 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1852 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1853 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1854
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001855tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1856 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1857 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1858 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1859 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1860 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1861 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001862 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001863
Willy Tarreauc55e3e12020-07-01 18:30:16 +02001864tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1865 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1866 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1867 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1868 default is 20.
1869
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001870tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1871tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1872 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1873 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1874 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001875 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001876 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001877 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1878 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1879
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001880tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001881 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001882 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1883 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1884 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1885 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1886
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001887tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001888 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001889 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1890 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1891
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001892tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1893tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1894 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1895 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1896 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001897 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001899 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1900 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1901 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1902 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1903 notifying haproxy again.
1904
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001905tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001906 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1907 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1908 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001909 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001910 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001911 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001912 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1913 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1914 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001915 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1916 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001917
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001918tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001919 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001920 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1921 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1922 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1923 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1924 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1925
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001926tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1927 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001928 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001929 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1930 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1931 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1932 being used for too long.
1933
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001934tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1935 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1936 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1937 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1938 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1939 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1940 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1941 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1942 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1943 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1944 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001945 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001946 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001947
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001948tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1949 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1950 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1951 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1952 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1953 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1954 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1955 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001956 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1957 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001958
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001959tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1960 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1961 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1962 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1963 1000 entries.
1964
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001965tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1966 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1967 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1968 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1969
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001970tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001971tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001972tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1973tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1974tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001975 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1976 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1977 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1978 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1979 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1980 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1981 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1982 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001983
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001984 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1985 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1986 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1987 all available space is consumed.
1988 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1989 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1990 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001991
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001992tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1993 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001994 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001995 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001996 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001997 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1998
1999tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2000 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2001 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002002 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2003 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020053.3. Debugging
2006--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002007
2008debug
2009 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2010 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2011 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2012 system startup.
2013
2014quiet
2015 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2016 line argument "-q".
2017
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020193.4. Userlists
2020--------------
2021It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2022http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2023it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2024
2025userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002026 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002027 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2028
2029group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002030 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002031 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2032 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2033
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002034user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2035 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002036 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2037 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002038 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2039 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2040 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2041 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002042
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002043 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2044 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2045 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2046 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2047 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2048 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2049 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2050 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2051 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002052
2053 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002054 userlist L1
2055 group G1 users tiger,scott
2056 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002057
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002058 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2059 user scott insecure-password elgato
2060 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002061
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002062 userlist L2
2063 group G1
2064 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002065
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002066 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2067 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2068 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002069
2070 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002071
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002072
20733.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002074----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002075It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2076several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2077instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2078values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2079automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2080In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2081using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2082tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2083reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2084Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2085that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2086each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002087
2088peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002089 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002090 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2091
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002092bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2093 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2094 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2095
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002096disabled
2097 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2098 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2099 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2100
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002101default-bind [param*]
2102 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2103
2104default-server [param*]
2105 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2106
2107 Arguments:
2108 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2109 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2110 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2111 details.
2112
2113
2114 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2115
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002116enable
2117 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2118
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002119peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002120 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2121 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2122 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2123 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2124 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2125 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2126
2127 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2128 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2129
2130 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2131 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2132 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2133 across all peers.
2134
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002135 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2136 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002137
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002138 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2139 "server" keyword explanation below).
2140
2141server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002142 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002143 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2144 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2145 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2146 of this "peers" section).
2147 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2148
2149
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002150 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002151 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002152 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002153 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2154 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2155 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002156
2157 backend mybackend
2158 mode tcp
2159 balance roundrobin
2160 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2161 stick on src
2162
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002163 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2164 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002165
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002166 Example:
2167 peers mypeers
2168 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2169 default-server ssl verify none
2170 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2171 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002172
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002173
2174table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2175 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2176
2177 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2178 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002179 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002180 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2181 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2182 "stick-table" keyword).
2183
2184 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2185 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2186 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2187 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2188 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2189 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2190 of the stick-table name as follows:
2191
2192 peers mypeers
2193 peer A ...
2194 peer B ...
2195 table t1 ...
2196
2197 frontend fe1
2198 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2199
2200 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2201 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2202
2203 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2204 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2205 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2206 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2207 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2208 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2209 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2210
2211 peers mypeers
2212 peer A ...
2213 peer B ...
2214 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2215
2216 backend t1
2217 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2218
2219 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2220 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2221 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2222
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022233.6. Mailers
2224------------
2225It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2226If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2227in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2228
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002229mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002230 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2231 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2232
2233mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2234 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2235
2236 Example:
2237 mailers mymailers
2238 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2239 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2240
2241 backend mybackend
2242 mode tcp
2243 balance roundrobin
2244
2245 email-alert mailers mymailers
2246 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2247 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2248
2249 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2250 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2251
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002252timeout mail <time>
2253 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2254 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2255 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2256 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2257
2258 Example:
2259 mailers mymailers
2260 timeout mail 20s
2261 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002262
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022633.7. Programs
2264-------------
2265In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2266master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2267managed the same way as the workers.
2268
2269During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2270sequence as a worker:
2271
2272 - the master is re-executed
2273 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2274 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2275 instance of the program
2276
2277During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2278
2279program <name>
2280 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2281 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2282 the management guide).
2283
2284command <command> [arguments*]
2285 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2286 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2287 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2288 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2289
2290option start-on-reload
2291no option start-on-reload
2292 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2293 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2294 program section.
2295
2296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022974. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002298----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002300Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002301 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002302 - frontend <name>
2303 - backend <name>
2304 - listen <name>
2305
2306A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2307its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2308section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002310
2311A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2312connections.
2313
2314A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2315to forward incoming connections.
2316
2317A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2318parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2321'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2322case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2323
2324Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2325logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2326proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2327However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2328name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2329
2330Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2331and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002332bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2334modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2335arbitrary criteria.
2336
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002337In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2338a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002339the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002340
2341 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2342 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2343 between responses and new requests.
2344
2345 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2346 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2347 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002348 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2349 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2350 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2351 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002352
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002353 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2354 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2355 client-facing connection remains open.
2356
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002357 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2358 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002359
2360The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2361frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2362following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002363weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002364
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002365 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002366
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002367 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2368 ----+-----+-----+----
2369 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2370 ----+-----+-----+----
2371 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2372 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2373 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2374 ----+-----+-----+----
2375 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023794.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2380--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002382The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2383limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2384they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2385limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002386marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002387option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002388and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2389with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2390specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002391
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002392
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002393 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2394------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2395acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002396backlog X X X -
2397balance X - X X
2398bind - X X -
2399bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002400block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002401capture cookie - X X -
2402capture request header - X X -
2403capture response header - X X -
2404clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002405compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002406contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2407cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002408declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002409default-server X - X X
2410default_backend X X X -
2411description - X X X
2412disabled X X X X
2413dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002414email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002415email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002416email-alert mailers X X X X
2417email-alert myhostname X X X X
2418email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002419enabled X X X X
2420errorfile X X X X
2421errorloc X X X X
2422errorloc302 X X X X
2423-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2424errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002425force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002426filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002427fullconn X - X X
2428grace X X X X
2429hash-type X - X X
2430http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002431http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002432http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002433http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002434http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002435http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002436http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002437id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002438ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002439load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002440log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002441log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002442log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002443log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002444max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002445maxconn X X X -
2446mode X X X X
2447monitor fail - X X -
2448monitor-net X X X -
2449monitor-uri X X X -
2450option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2451option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2452option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2453option allbackups (*) X - X X
2454option checkcache (*) X - X X
2455option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2456option contstats (*) X X X -
2457option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2458option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002459-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2460option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002461option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2462option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002463option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002464option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002465option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002466option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002467option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002468option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002469option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002471option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002472option httpchk X - X X
2473option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002474option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002475option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002476option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002477option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002478option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002479option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2480option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2481option logasap (*) X X X -
2482option mysql-check X - X X
2483option nolinger (*) X X X X
2484option originalto X X X X
2485option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002486option pgsql-check X - X X
2487option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002488option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002489option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002490option smtpchk X - X X
2491option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2492option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2493option splice-request (*) X X X X
2494option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002495option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002496option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2497option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2498-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002499option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002500option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2501option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2502option tcpka X X X X
2503option tcplog X X X X
2504option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002505external-check command X - X X
2506external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002507persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2508rate-limit sessions X X X -
2509redirect - X X X
2510redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2511redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002512reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2513reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2514reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2515reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2521reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2522reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2523reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002524-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002525reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002526retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002527retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002528rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2529rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2530rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2531rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2532rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2533rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2534rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002535server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002536server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002537server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002538source X - X X
2539srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002540stats admin - X X X
2541stats auth X X X X
2542stats enable X X X X
2543stats hide-version X X X X
2544stats http-request - X X X
2545stats realm X X X X
2546stats refresh X X X X
2547stats scope X X X X
2548stats show-desc X X X X
2549stats show-legends X X X X
2550stats show-node X X X X
2551stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002552-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2553stick match - - X X
2554stick on - - X X
2555stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002556stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002557stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002558tcp-check connect - - X X
2559tcp-check expect - - X X
2560tcp-check send - - X X
2561tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002562tcp-request connection - X X -
2563tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002564tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002565tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002566tcp-response content - - X X
2567tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002568timeout check X - X X
2569timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002570timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002571timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2572timeout connect X - X X
2573timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2574timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2575timeout http-request X X X X
2576timeout queue X - X X
2577timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002578timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002579timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2580timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002581timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002582transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002583unique-id-format X X X -
2584unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002585use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002586use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002587------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2588 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002589
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2592---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002593
2594This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2595
2596
2597acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2598 Declare or complete an access list.
2599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2600 no | yes | yes | yes
2601 Example:
2602 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2603 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2604 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002606 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
2608
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002609backlog <conns>
2610 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 yes | yes | yes | no
2613 Arguments :
2614 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2615 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002616 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002617
2618 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2619 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2620 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2621 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2622 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2623 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2624 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2625 backlog parameter.
2626
2627 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2628 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2629 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2630
2631 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2632
2633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002635balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002636 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2638 yes | no | yes | yes
2639 Arguments :
2640 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2641 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2642 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2643 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2644
2645 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2646 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2647 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2648 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002649 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002650 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002651 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2652 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2653 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2654 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2655 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2656 it, so that you don't worry.
2657
2658 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2659 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2660 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2661 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2662 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2663 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2664 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2665 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002666
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002667 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2668 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2669 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2670 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2671 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2672 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2673 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2674 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2675
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002676 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002677 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002678 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2679 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002680 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002681 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2682 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2683 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2684 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2685 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002686 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2687 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2688 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2689 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2690 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2691 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002692
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002693 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2694 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2695 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2696 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2697 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2698 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2699 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2700 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002701 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002703 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2704 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2705 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002706
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002707 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2708 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2709 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2710 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2711 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2712 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2713 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2714 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2715 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2716 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2717 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2718 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002720 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002721 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2722 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2723 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2724 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2725 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2726 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2727 URIs start with a leading "/".
2728
2729 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2730 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2731 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2732 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002735 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2736
2737 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002738 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2739 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002740 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2741 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2742 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2743 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002744 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002745 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2746 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002747
2748 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2749 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2750 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2751 server will receive the request.
2752
2753 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2754 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2755 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2756 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2757 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002758 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2759 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2760 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002762 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2763 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2764 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2765 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2766 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002768 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002769 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2770 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2771 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2772
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002773 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2774 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2775 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2776
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002777 random
2778 random(<draws>)
2779 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002780 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2781 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2782 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2783 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002784 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2785 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2786 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2787 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2788 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2789 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2790 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2791 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2792 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2793 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2794 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2795 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2796 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2797 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2798 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2799 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2800 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2801 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2802 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2803 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002804
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002805 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002806 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002807 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2808 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2809 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2810 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2811 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2812 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002813 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002814 used instead.
2815
2816 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2817 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2818 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2819 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2820
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002821 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2822 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2823 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2824
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002825 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002826
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002827 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002828 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2829 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002830
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002831 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2832 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2833 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002834
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002835 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002836 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002837 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2838 NTLM relies on.
2839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840 Examples :
2841 balance roundrobin
2842 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002843 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002844 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2845 balance hdr(host)
2846 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002847
2848 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2849 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002851 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002852 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2853 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2854 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2855 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2856
2857 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2858 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2859 defaults to 16 kB.
2860
2861 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2862 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2863
2864 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2865 Round Robin.
2866
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002867 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002868 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2869 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2870 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2871
2872 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2873
2874 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002875 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002876 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2877 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2878 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002879
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002880 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881
2882
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002883bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2884bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002885 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2887 no | yes | yes | no
2888 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002889 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2890 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2891 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2892 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002893 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002894 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2895 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2896 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2897 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2898 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2899 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2900 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002901 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2902 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2903 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2904 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2905 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2906 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2907 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002908 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2909 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2910 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002911 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2912 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2913 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2914 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002915 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2916 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2917 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002918
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002919 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2920 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002921 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2922 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2923 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002924 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2925 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2926 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2927 the range.
2928
2929 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2930 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2931 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2932 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2933 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2934 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2935 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002936 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002937 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002939 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002940 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002941 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2942 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2943 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2944 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2945 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2946 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2947
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002948 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2949 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2950 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2951 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002952
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002953 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2954 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2955 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2956 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2957 in a frontend.
2958
2959 Example :
2960 listen http_proxy
2961 bind :80,:443
2962 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002963 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002965 listen http_https_proxy
2966 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002967 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002968
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002969 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2970 bind ipv6@:80
2971 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2972 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2973
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002974 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002975 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002976
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002977 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2978 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2979 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2980 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2981 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2982
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002983 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002984 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002985
2986
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002987bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002988 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2990 yes | yes | yes | yes
2991 Arguments :
2992 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2993 may be used to override a default value.
2994
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002995 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002996 option may be combined with other numbers.
2997
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002998 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002999 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3000 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3001 missing from all processes.
3002
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003003 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003004 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003005 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3006 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3007 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3008 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3009 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003010 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003011
3012 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3013 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3014 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3015 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3016 and 'even' instances.
3017
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003018 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3019 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3020 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3021 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003022
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003023 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3024 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3025
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003026 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3027 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3028 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3029
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003030 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3031 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3032
3033 Example :
3034 listen app_ip1
3035 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003036 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003037
3038 listen app_ip2
3039 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003040 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003041
3042 listen management
3043 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003044 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003045
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003046 listen management
3047 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3048 bind-process 1-4
3049
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003050 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003051
3052
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003053block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003054 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 no | yes | yes | yes
3057
3058 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3059 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003060 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003061 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003062 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003063 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3064 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3065 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003067 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3068 "http-request deny" instead.
3069
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070 Example:
3071 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3072 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3073 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003074 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3075 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3076 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003078 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3079 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3080 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003081
3082capture cookie <name> len <length>
3083 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 no | yes | yes | no
3086 Arguments :
3087 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3088 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3089 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3090 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003091 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003092
3093 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3094 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3095 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3096 right if it exceeds <length>.
3097
3098 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3099 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3100 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3101 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3102
3103 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3104 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3105 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3106
3107 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3108 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3109 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003110 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3111 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3112 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003113
3114 Example:
3115 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3116
3117 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003118 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003119
3120
3121capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003122 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 no | yes | yes | no
3125 Arguments :
3126 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003127 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3129 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3130 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3131
3132 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3133 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3134 it exceeds <length>.
3135
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003136 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003137 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3138 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003139 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3140 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3141 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3142 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003143 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003144 environments to find where the request came from.
3145
3146 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3147 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3148 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3149 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003150
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003151 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3152 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3153 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3154 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3155 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156
3157 Example:
3158 capture request header Host len 15
3159 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003160 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003162 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003163 about logging.
3164
3165
3166capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003167 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3169 no | yes | yes | no
3170 Arguments :
3171 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003172 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003173 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3174 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3175 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3176
3177 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3178 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3179 it exceeds <length>.
3180
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003181 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003182 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3183 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3184 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003185 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3186 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3187 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3188 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003189
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003190 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3191 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3192 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3193 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3194 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003195
3196 Example:
3197 capture response header Content-length len 9
3198 capture response header Location len 15
3199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003200 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003201 about logging.
3202
3203
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003204clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003205 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3207 yes | yes | yes | no
3208 Arguments :
3209 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3211 as explained at the top of this document.
3212
3213 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3214 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3215 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3216 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3217 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3218 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3219 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3220 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003221 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003222 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003223 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224
3225 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3226 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3227 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3228 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3229 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3230 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3231
3232 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3233 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3234
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003235 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3236 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003237
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003238compression algo <algorithm> ...
3239compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003240compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003241 Enable HTTP compression.
3242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3243 yes | yes | yes | yes
3244 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003245 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3246 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3247 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3248
3249 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003250 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3251 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3252 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003253
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003254 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003255 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003256
3257 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3258 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3259 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3260 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3261 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003262 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003263
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003264 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3265 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3266 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3267 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3268 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3269 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3270 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003271 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003272
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003273 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003274 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003275 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3276 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3277 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3278 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3279 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003280
3281 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3282 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3283 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3284 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3285 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003286 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3287 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3288 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3289 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3290 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003291 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3292 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003293
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003294 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003295 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3296 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivotto5380be22021-03-29 12:41:40 +02003297 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003298 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003299 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3300 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3301 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3302 "multipart"
3303 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3304 header
3305 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3306 and later
3307 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3308 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003309 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003310
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003311 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003312
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003313 Examples :
3314 compression algo gzip
3315 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003316
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003317
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003318contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3321 yes | no | yes | yes
3322 Arguments :
3323 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3324 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3325 as explained at the top of this document.
3326
3327 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003328 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003329 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003330 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003331 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3332 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3333 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3334
3335 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3336 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3337 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3338 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3339 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3340 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3341
3342 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3343 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3344 instead.
3345
3346 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3347 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3348
3349
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003350cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003351 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3352 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003353 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3356 yes | no | yes | yes
3357 Arguments :
3358 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3359 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3360 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3361 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3362 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3363 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003364 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003365 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3366 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3367
3368 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3369 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3370 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3371 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3372 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3373 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003374 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3375 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003376 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003377 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3378 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003379
3380 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003381 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003382
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003383 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003384 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003385 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003386 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003387 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3388 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3389 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3390 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3391 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3392 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3393 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003394
3395 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3396 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3397 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3398 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3399 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3400 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3401 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3402 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3403 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003404 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003405 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3406 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3407 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003409 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3410 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3411 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003412 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3413 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3414 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3415 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003416 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3417 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3418 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419
3420 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3421 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3422 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3423 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3424 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3425 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3426 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3427 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3428 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3429
3430 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3431 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3432 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3433 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3434 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3435 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3436 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3437 persistence cookie in the cache.
3438 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3439
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003440 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3441 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3442 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3443 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3444 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003445 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003446 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3447 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3448 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3449 they logout.
3450
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003451 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3452 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3453 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3454 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3455
3456 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3457 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3458 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3459 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3460 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3461 this attribute.
3462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003463 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003464 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003465 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3466 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3467 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3468 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3469 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3470 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003471
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003472 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3473 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3474 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3475 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3476 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3477 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3478 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3479 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003480 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003481 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3482 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3483 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3484 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3485 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3486 the site.
3487
3488 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3489 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3490 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3491 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3492 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3493 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3494 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3495 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3496 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3497 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3498 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3499 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3500 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003501 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003502 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3503 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3504
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003505 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3506 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3507 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3508 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3509 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3510 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3511
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003512 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3513 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3514 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3515 repeated.
3516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3518 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3519 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3520 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003521
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522 Examples :
3523 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3524 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3525 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003526 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003527
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003528 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003530
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003531declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3532 Declares a capture slot.
3533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3534 no | yes | yes | no
3535 Arguments:
3536 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3537
3538 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3539 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3540 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3541 for use in the response.
3542
3543 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003544 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003545 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3546
3547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003548default-server [param*]
3549 Change default options for a server in a backend
3550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3551 yes | no | yes | yes
3552 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003553 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3554 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3555 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3556 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003557
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003558 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003559 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3560
3561 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003562
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003564default_backend <backend>
3565 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3567 yes | yes | yes | no
3568 Arguments :
3569 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3570
3571 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3572 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3573 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3574 will catch all undetermined requests.
3575
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003576 Example :
3577
3578 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3579 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3580 default_backend dynamic
3581
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003582 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003583
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003584
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003585description <string>
3586 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3588 no | yes | yes | yes
3589 Arguments : string
3590
3591 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3592 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3593 it describes.
3594 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3595
3596
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003597disabled
3598 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3600 yes | yes | yes | yes
3601 Arguments : none
3602
3603 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3604 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3605 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3606 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3607 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3608 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3609 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3610
3611 See also : "enabled"
3612
3613
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003614dispatch <address>:<port>
3615 Set a default server address
3616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3617 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003618 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003619
3620 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3621 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3622 during start-up.
3623
3624 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3625 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3626 possible with normal servers.
3627
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003628 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003629 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3630 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3631 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3632 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3633
3634 See also : "server"
3635
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003636
3637dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3638 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3640 yes | no | yes | yes
3641 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3642
3643 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003644 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003645 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3646 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003647 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003648 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003650enabled
3651 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3653 yes | yes | yes | yes
3654 Arguments : none
3655
3656 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3657 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3658
3659 See also : "disabled"
3660
3661
3662errorfile <code> <file>
3663 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 yes | yes | yes | yes
3666 Arguments :
3667 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003668 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3669 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003670
3671 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003672 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003673 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003674 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3675 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003676
3677 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3678 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3679 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3680
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003681 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003683 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3684 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3685 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3686 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3687
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003688 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3689 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003690 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003691 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3692 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3693 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003695 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3696 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3697 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003698 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003699 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3700
3701 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3702
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003703 Example :
3704 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003705 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003706 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3707 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3708
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003709
3710errorloc <code> <url>
3711errorloc302 <code> <url>
3712 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3714 yes | yes | yes | yes
3715 Arguments :
3716 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003717 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3718 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003719
3720 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3721 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3722 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3723 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003724 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003725
3726 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3727 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3728 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3729
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003730 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003732 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3733 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3734 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3735 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003736 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003737 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3738 request.
3739
3740 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3741
3742
3743errorloc303 <code> <url>
3744 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3746 yes | yes | yes | yes
3747 Arguments :
3748 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003749 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3750 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003751
3752 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3753 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3754 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3755 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003756 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003757
3758 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3759 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3760 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3761
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003762 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3763
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003764 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3765 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3766 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3767 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003768 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003769
3770 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3771
3772
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003773email-alert from <emailaddr>
3774 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003775 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3777 yes | yes | yes | yes
3778
3779 Arguments :
3780
3781 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3782
3783 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3784 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3785
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003786 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003787 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3788 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003789
3790
3791email-alert level <level>
3792 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3793 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3795 yes | yes | yes | yes
3796
3797 Arguments :
3798
3799 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3800 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3801 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3802
3803 By default level is alert
3804
3805 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3806 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3807 for the proxy.
3808
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003809 Alerts are sent when :
3810
3811 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3812 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3813 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3814 is notice or lower
3815 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3816 and a health check status update occurs
3817
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003818 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3819 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003820 section 3.6 about mailers.
3821
3822
3823email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3824 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3826 yes | yes | yes | yes
3827
3828 Arguments :
3829
3830 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3831
3832 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3833 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3834
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003835 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3836 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003837
3838
3839email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3840 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3841 mailers.
3842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3843 yes | yes | yes | yes
3844
3845 Arguments :
3846
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003847 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003848
3849 By default the systems hostname is used.
3850
3851 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3852 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3853 for the proxy.
3854
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003855 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3856 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003857
3858
3859email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003860 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003861 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3862 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3863 yes | yes | yes | yes
3864
3865 Arguments :
3866
3867 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3868
3869 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3870 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3871
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003872 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003873 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3874
3875
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003876force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3877 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3878 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003879 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003880
3881 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3882 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3883 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3884 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3885 marked down for maintenance operations.
3886
3887 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3888 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3889 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3890 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3891 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3892 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3893 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3894 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3895 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3896
3897 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3898 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3899 is used.
3900
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003901 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003902 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003903
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003904
3905filter <name> [param*]
3906 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 no | yes | yes | yes
3909 Arguments :
3910 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3911 referenced in section 9.
3912
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003913 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003914 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003915 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3916 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003917
3918 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3919 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3920
3921 Example:
3922 listen
3923 bind *:80
3924
3925 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3926 filter compression
3927 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3928
3929 compression algo gzip
3930 compression offload
3931
3932 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3933
3934 See also : section 9.
3935
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003936
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003937fullconn <conns>
3938 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3940 yes | no | yes | yes
3941 Arguments :
3942 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3943 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3944
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003945 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003946 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003947 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003948 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3949 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3950 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3951 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3952 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003953 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003954
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003955 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3956 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003957 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3958 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3959 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003960
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003961 Example :
3962 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3963 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3964 # connections.
3965 backend dynamic
3966 fullconn 10000
3967 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3968 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3969
3970 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3971
3972
3973grace <time>
3974 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003976 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003977 Arguments :
3978 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3979 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3980 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3981
3982 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3983 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003984 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003985 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3986
3987 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3988 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3989 simplify it.
3990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003991
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003992hash-balance-factor <factor>
3993 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3995 yes | no | no | yes
3996 Arguments :
3997 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3998 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003999 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004000
4001 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4002 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4003 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4004 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4005 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4006 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4007 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4008
4009 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4010 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4011 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4012 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4013 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4014
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004015 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4016 consistent hashing mechanism.
4017
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004018 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4019
4020
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004021hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004022 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4024 yes | no | yes | yes
4025 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004026 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4027 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004028
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004029 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4030 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4031 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4032 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4033 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4034 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4035 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4036 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4037 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4038 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004039
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004040 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4041 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4042 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4043 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4044 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4045 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4046 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4047 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4048 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4049 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4050 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4051 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4052 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004053 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4054 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004055
4056 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4057
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004058 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004059 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4060 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4061 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004062 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4063 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4064 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004065
4066 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4067 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004068 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4069 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4070 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4071 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4072
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004073 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4074 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4075 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4076 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4077 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4078 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4079 parameter.
4080
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004081 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4082 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4083 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4084 used on strings.
4085
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004086 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4087
4088 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4089 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4090 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4091 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4092 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4093 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4094 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4095 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4096 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4097 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4098 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4099 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004100
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004101 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4102 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4103 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004104
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004105 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004106
4107
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004108http-check disable-on-404
4109 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004111 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004112 Arguments : none
4113
4114 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4115 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4116 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4117 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4118 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4119 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4120 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4121 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004122 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4123 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4124 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4125
4126 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4127
4128
4129http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004130 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004132 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004133 Arguments :
4134 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4135 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004136 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004137 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4138 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4139 details on the supported keywords.
4140
4141 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4142 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4143 with the usual backslash ('\').
4144
4145 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4146 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4147 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4148 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4149 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4150
4151 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004152 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004153 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4154 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4155 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4156
4157 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004158 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004159 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4160 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4161 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4162 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4163
4164 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004165 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004166 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4167 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4168 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4169 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4170 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004171 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004172 trace).
4173
4174 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004175 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004176 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4177 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4178 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4179 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4180 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004181 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004182
4183 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4184 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4185 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4186 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4187 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4188 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4189 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4190 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4191
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004192 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4193 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4194 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4195
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004196 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4197 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4198
4199 Examples :
4200 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004201 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004202
4203 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004204 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004205
4206 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004207 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004208
4209 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004210 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004211
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004212 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004213
4214
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004215http-check send [hdr <name> <value>]* [body <string>]
4216 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4217 health checks.
4218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4219 yes | no | yes | yes
4220 Arguments :
4221 hdr <name> <value> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4222 <name> and whose value is defined by <value> to the
4223 request sent during HTTP health checks.
4224
4225 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent
4226 sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4227 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added
4228 to the request.
4229
4230 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4231 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4232 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4233 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4234 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4235 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4236 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4237 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4238
4239 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect"
4240
4241
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004242http-check send-state
4243 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4245 yes | no | yes | yes
4246 Arguments : none
4247
4248 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4249 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4250 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4251 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4252 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4253
4254 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4255 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4256 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4257 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4258 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004259 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4260 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4261 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4262
4263 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4264 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4265 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4266
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004267 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4268 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4269 checked in multiple backends.
4270
4271 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4272 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4273
4274 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4275 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4276 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4277 one fails.
4278
4279 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4280 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4281 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4282
4283 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4284 server's queue.
4285
4286 Example of a header received by the application server :
4287 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4288 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4289
4290 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292
4293http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004294 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4295
4296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 no | yes | yes | yes
4298
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004299 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4300 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4301 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4302 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4303 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4306 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004308 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004310 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4311 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4312 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4313 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004315 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4316 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4317 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4318 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320 Example:
4321 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4322 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4323 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325 http-request allow if nagios
4326 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4327 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4328 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004330 Example:
4331 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4332 acl add path /addacl
4333 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4338 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 Example:
4341 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4342 acl setmap path /setmap
4343 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004345 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004347 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4348 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4351 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004355 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4356 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4357 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4358 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4359 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4360 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4361 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4362 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004364http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004366 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4367 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4368 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4369 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4370 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4371 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4372 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4373 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004375http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004377 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4378 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004379
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004381http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004383 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4384 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4385 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4386 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4387 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004388
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004389 Example:
4390 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4391 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004392
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004393http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4398 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4401 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4402 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4403 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4404 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4405 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4406 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4407 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4408 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004410 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4411 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4412 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004413 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4414
4415 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4416 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4417 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4418 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004420http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004422 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4423 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4424 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4425 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4426 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4427 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004433http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4436 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4437 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4438 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4439 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4440 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004442http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4445 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4446 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4447 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4448 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004449
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004450http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4451 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4452 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4453 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4454
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004455http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4456
4457 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4458 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4459 pointed by <resolvers>.
4460 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4461 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4462 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4463 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4464 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4465 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4466 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4467 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4468 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4469 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4470 to 0.0.0.0.
4471
4472 Example:
4473 resolvers mydns
4474 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4475 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4476 timeout retry 1s
4477 hold valid 10s
4478 hold nx 3s
4479 hold other 3s
4480 hold obsolete 0s
4481 accepted_payload_size 8192
4482
4483 frontend fe
4484 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4485 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4486 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4487
4488 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4489 # which mean DNS resolution error
4490 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4491
4492 default_backend be
4493
4494 backend b_503
4495 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4496 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4497 # 503 error page to end users
4498
4499 backend be
4500 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4501 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4502 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4503 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4504 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4505
4506 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4507 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4508
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004509http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4510
4511 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4512 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4513 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4514 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004515 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4516 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004517
4518 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004520http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004522 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4523 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4524 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4525 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4526 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004528http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4531 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4532 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4533 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004535http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4536 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004537
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004538 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004539 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4540 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4541 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4542 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4543 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004544
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004545 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4546 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4547 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4548 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4549 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004550
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004551 Example:
4552 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4553
4554 # applied to:
4555 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4556
4557 # outputs:
4558 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4559
4560 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004561
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004562 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4563
4564 # applied to:
4565 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004566
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004567 # outputs:
4568 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004569
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004570http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4571 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4572
4573 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4574 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet99721282020-09-02 14:16:59 +02004575 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
4576 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
4577 query-string.
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004578
4579 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4580 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4581 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4582
4583 Example:
4584 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4585 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4586
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004587 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4588 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4589 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4590 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4591
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004592http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4593 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4594
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004595 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4596 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4597 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4598 against.
4599
4600 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4601 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4602 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004603
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004604 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4605 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4606 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4607 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4608 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4609 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4610 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4611 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4612 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004613 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4614 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004615
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004616 Example:
4617 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4618 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004619
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004620 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4621 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4624 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004625
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004626 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4627 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4628 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4629 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004630
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004631 Example:
4632 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004633
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004634 # applied to:
4635 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004636
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004637 # outputs:
4638 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004640http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4641http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004643 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4644 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4645 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004647http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4650 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4651 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004653http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004655 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4656 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4657 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4658 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4659 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004661 Arguments:
4662 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4663 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004665 Example:
4666 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4667 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4670 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004672http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4675 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4676 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004678 Arguments:
4679 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4680 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004682 Example:
4683 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4684 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004686 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4687 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4688 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004690http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004692 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4693 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4694 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4695 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4696 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004698 Example:
4699 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4700 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4701 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4702 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4703 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4704 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4705 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4706 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4707 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004709http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004711 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4712 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4713 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4714 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4715 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004717http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4718 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004720 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4721 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4722 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4723 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4724 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4725 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4726 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4727 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4728 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004729
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004730http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004732 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4733 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4734 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4735 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4736 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4737 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4738 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004740http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004742 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4743 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4744 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004746http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004748 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4749 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4750 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4751 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4752 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4753 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4754 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4755 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004756
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004757http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004758
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004759 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4760 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4761 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4762 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4763 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4764 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004765
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004766 Example :
4767 # prepend the host name before the path
4768 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004769
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004770http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004771
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004772 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4773 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4774 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4775 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4776 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004778http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004779
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004780 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4781 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4782 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4783 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4784 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4785 values have higher priority.
4786 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4787 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4788 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4789 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4790 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004791
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004792http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004794 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4795 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4796 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4797 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4798 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4799 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4800 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004802 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004803
4804 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004805 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4806 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004808http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4809 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4810 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4811 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004812 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
4813 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004814
4815 Arguments :
4816 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4817 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004818
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004819 See also "option forwardfor".
4820
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004821 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004822 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4823 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4824
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004825 # After the masking this will track connections
4826 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
4827 http-request track-sc0 src
4828
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004829 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4830 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4831
4832http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4833
4834 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4835 expression.
4836
4837 Arguments:
4838 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4839 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004840
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004841 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004842 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4843 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4844
4845 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4846 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4847 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4848
4849http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4850
4851 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4852 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4853 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4854 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4855 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4856 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4857 information from the request.
4858
4859 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4860
4861http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4862
4863 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4864 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4865 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4866 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4867 path and the query string.
4868 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4869
4870http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4871
4872 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4873 inline.
4874
4875 Arguments:
4876 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4877 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4878 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4879 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4880 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4881 (request and response)
4882 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4883 processing
4884 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4885 processing
4886 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4887 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4888 and '_'.
4889
4890 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4891 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004892
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004893 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004894 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004895
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004896http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4897 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004899 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4900 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4901 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4902 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4903 agent name must be used.
4904
4905 Arguments:
4906 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4907
4908 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4909 configuration.
4910
4911http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4912
4913 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4914 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4915 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4916 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4917 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4918 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4919 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4920 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4921 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4922 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4923 action.
4924 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4925 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4926 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4927 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4928 you fully understand how it works.
4929
4930http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4931
4932 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4933 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4934 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4935 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4936 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4937 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4938 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4939 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4940 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4941 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4942 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4943 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4944 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4945
4946http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4947http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4948http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4949
4950 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4951 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4952 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4953 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4954 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4955 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4956 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4957 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4958 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4959 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4960 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4961 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4962
4963 Arguments :
4964 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4965 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4966 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4967 select which table entry to update the counters.
4968
4969 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4970 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4971 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4972 that table until the session ends.
4973
4974 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4975 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4976 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4977 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4978 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4979 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4980 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4981 useful information.
4982
4983 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4984 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4985 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4986 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4987 checks that make use of it.
4988
4989http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4990
4991 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004992
4993 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004994 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004995
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004996http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4997
4998 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4999 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5000 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5001 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5002 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5003 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5004
5005 Arguments :
5006 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5007
5008 Example:
5009 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005011http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005013 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5014 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5015 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005016
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005018http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005019 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5020
5021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 no | yes | yes | yes
5023
5024 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5025 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5026 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5027 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5028 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5029 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005031 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5032 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
5037 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
5038 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
5039 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
5042 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
5043 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
5044 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005046 Example:
5047 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005049 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005051 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5052 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005054 Example:
5055 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005057 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005059 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5060 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5063 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005065http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005067 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5068 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5069 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5070 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5071 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5072 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5073 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5074 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005076http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005078 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5079 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5080 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5081 example, or to pass some internal information.
5082 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5083 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5084 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005086http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005088 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5089 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005090
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005091http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005093 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005095http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005097 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5098 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5099 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5100 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5101 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5102 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5103 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005105 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5106 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5107 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5108 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5109 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005110
5111 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5112 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5113 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5114 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005116http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005118 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5119 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5120 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5121 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5122 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5123 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005124
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005125http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005126
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005127 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005128
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005129http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005131 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5132 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5133 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5134 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5135 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5136 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005137
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005138http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005140 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5141 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005143http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005145 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5146 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5147 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5148 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5149 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5150 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005152http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5153 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005154
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005155 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5156 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005158 Example:
5159 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005161 # applied to:
5162 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005164 # outputs:
5165 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005167 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005169http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5170 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005171
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005172 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5173 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005175 Example:
5176 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005177
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005178 # applied to:
5179 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005181 # outputs:
5182 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005184http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5185http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005187 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5188 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5189 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005190
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005191http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005193 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5194 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5195 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005197http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005199 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5200 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5201 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5202 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5203 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005204
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005205 Arguments:
5206 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005208 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5209 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005211http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005213 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5214 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5215 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005216
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005217http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5218
5219 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5220 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5221 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5222 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5223 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5224
5225http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5226
5227 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5228 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5229 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5230 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5231 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5232 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5233 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5234 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5235 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5236
5237http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5238
5239 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5240 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5241 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5242 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5243 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5244 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5245 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5246
5247http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5248
5249 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5250 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5251 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5252 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5253 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5254 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5255 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5256 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5257
5258http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5259 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5260
5261 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5262 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5263 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5264 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005265
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005266 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005267 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5268 http-response set-status 431
5269 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5270 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005271
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005272http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005273
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005274 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5275 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5276 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5277 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5278 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5279 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5280 based on some information from the request.
5281
5282 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5283
5284http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5285
5286 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5287 inline.
5288
5289 Arguments:
5290 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5291 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5292 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5293 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5294 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5295 (request and response)
5296 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5297 processing
5298 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5299 processing
5300 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5301 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5302 and '_'.
5303
5304 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5305 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005306
5307 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005308 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005309
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005310http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005311
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005312 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5313 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5314 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5315 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5316 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5317 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5318 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5319 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5320 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5321 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5322 action.
5323 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5324 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5325 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5326 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5327 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005328
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005329http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5330http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5331http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005332
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005333 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5334 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5335 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5336 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5337 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5338 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5339
5340http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5341
5342 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5343 about <var-name>.
5344
5345 Example:
5346 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5347
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005348
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005349http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5350 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5351
5352 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5353 yes | no | yes | yes
5354
5355 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005356 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5357 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5358 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005359
5360 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5361
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005362 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5363 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5364 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5365 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5366 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5367 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5368 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5369 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5370 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5371 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005372
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005373 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5374 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5375 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5376 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5377 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5378 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5379 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5380 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005381
5382 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5383 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5384 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5385 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5386 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5387 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5388 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5389 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005390 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005391 downsides of rare connection failures.
5392
5393 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5394 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5395 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5396 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5397 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5398 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005399 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005400 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5401 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5402 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5403 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5404 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5405
5406 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005407 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5408 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5409 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005410
5411 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005412 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005413
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005414 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5415 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005416
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005417 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005418
5419 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5420 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5421 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5422
5423 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5424
5425
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005426http-send-name-header [<header>]
5427 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5429 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005430 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005431 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5432
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005433 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5434 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5435 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5436 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5437 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5438 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5439 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5440 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5441 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5442 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5443 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5444 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5445 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5446 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5447 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5448 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005449
5450 See also : "server"
5451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005452id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005453 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5455 no | yes | yes | yes
5456 Arguments : none
5457
5458 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5459 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5460 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005461
5462
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005463ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5464 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005466 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005467
5468 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5469 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5470 and running).
5471
5472 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5473 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5474 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005475 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005476 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5477
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005478 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5479 "unless" condition is met.
5480
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005481 Example:
5482 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5483 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5484 ignore-persist if url_static
5485
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005486 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5487
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005488load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5489 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5490 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5491 yes | no | yes | yes
5492
5493 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5494 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5495 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005496 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005497 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5498 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5499 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5500 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5501
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005502 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005503 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005504 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005505
5506 Arguments:
5507 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5508 named "server-state-file".
5509
5510 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5511 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5512 name is used as a file name.
5513
5514 none don't load any stat for this backend
5515
5516 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005517 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5518 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5519 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005520 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005521 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005522
5523 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5524 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5525
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005526 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005527
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005528 global
5529 stats socket /tmp/socket
5530 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005531
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005532 defaults
5533 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005534
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005535 backend bk
5536 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5537 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005538
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005539
5540 Then one can run :
5541
5542 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5543
5544 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5545
5546 1
5547 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5548 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5549 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5550
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005551 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005552
5553 global
5554 stats socket /tmp/socket
5555 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5556
5557 defaults
5558 load-server-state-from-file local
5559
5560 backend bk
5561 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5562 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5563
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005564
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005565 Then one can run :
5566
5567 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5568
5569 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5570
5571 1
5572 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5573 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5574 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5575
5576 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5577 "show servers state"
5578
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005579
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005580log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005581log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5582 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005583no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005584 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005587
5588 Prefix :
5589 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5590 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5591 prefix does not allow arguments.
5592
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005593 Arguments :
5594 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5595 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5596 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5597 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5598 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5599 parameter.
5600
5601 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5602 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5603
5604 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5605 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5606 standard syslog port).
5607
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005608 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5609 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5610 standard syslog port).
5611
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005612 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5613 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5614 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005615 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005616
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005617 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5618 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5619 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5620 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5621 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5622 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5623 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5624 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5625 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5626 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5627 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5628 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5629 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5630 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5631 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5632 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005633 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5634 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005635
5636 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5637 and "fd@2", see above.
5638
5639 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5640 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005641
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005642 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5643 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5644 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5645 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5646 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5647 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5648 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5649 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5650 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5651 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005652 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005653
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005654 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5655 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5656 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5657 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5658 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5659
5660 <sample_size>
5661 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5662 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5663 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5664 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5665 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5666
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005667 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5668 one of the following :
5669
5670 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5671 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5672
5673 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5674 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5675
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005676 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5677 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5678 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5679 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5680 systemd logger consumes.
5681
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005682 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5683 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5684 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5685 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5686
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005687 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5688
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005689 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5690 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5691 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5692
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005693 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5694 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5695 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5696 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005697
5698 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5699 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5700 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005701 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5702 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5703 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5704 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5705 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005706
5707 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5708
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005709 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5710 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5711 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005712
5713 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5714 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5715 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5716 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5717
5718 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5719 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005720
5721 Example :
5722 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005723 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5724 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5725 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005726 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5727 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005728 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005729
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005730
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005731log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005732 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5733 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5734 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005735
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005736 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5737 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5738 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5739 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5740 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005741
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005742 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5743 "option httplog" directives.
5744
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005745log-format-sd <string>
5746 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5748 yes | yes | yes | no
5749
5750 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5751 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5752 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5753 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5754 which covers the log format string in depth.
5755
5756 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5757 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5758
5759 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5760 log format to "rfc5424".
5761
5762 Example :
5763 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5764
5765
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005766log-tag <string>
5767 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5768 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5769 yes | yes | yes | yes
5770
5771 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5772 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5773 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5774 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5775 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5776 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5777 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5778 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5779 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005780
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005781max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5782 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5783 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5784 yes | no | yes | yes
5785
5786 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5787 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5788 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5789 servers.
5790
5791 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5792 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5793 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5794 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5795 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005796 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005797 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5798 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5799 picking a different server.
5800
5801 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5802 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5803 even if they have to be queued.
5804
5805 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5806 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5807
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005808max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5809 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5810 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5811 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005812
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005813maxconn <conns>
5814 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5816 yes | yes | yes | no
5817 Arguments :
5818 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5819 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5820 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5821 closes.
5822
5823 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5824 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5825 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5826 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005827 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5828 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5829 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5830 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005831
5832 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5833 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5834 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5835
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005836 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5837 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005838
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005839 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5840
5841
5842mode { tcp|http|health }
5843 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5845 yes | yes | yes | yes
5846 Arguments :
5847 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5848 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5849 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5850 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5851
5852 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5853 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5854 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5855 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5856 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5857
5858 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005859 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5860 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5861 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5862 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5863 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5864 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5865 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005866
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005867 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5868 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5869 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005870
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005871 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005872 defaults http_instances
5873 mode http
5874
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005875 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005876
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005877
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005878monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005879 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5881 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005882 Arguments :
5883 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5884 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005885 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005886 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5887 backend and its backup.
5888
5889 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5890 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5891 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5892 servers in a list of backends.
5893
5894 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5895 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5896 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5897 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5898 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5899 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5900 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005901 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5902 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005903
5904 Example:
5905 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005906 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005907 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5908 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5909 monitor-uri /site_alive
5910 monitor fail if site_dead
5911
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005912 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005913
5914
5915monitor-net <source>
5916 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5918 yes | yes | yes | no
5919 Arguments :
5920 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5921 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5922 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5923 followed by a mask.
5924
5925 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5926 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005927 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005928 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5929
5930 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5931 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5932 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5933 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005934 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5935 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5936 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005937
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005938 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5939 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5940 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5941 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5942 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5943 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005944
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005945 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5946 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005947
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005948 Example :
5949 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5950 frontend www
5951 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5952
5953 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5954
5955
5956monitor-uri <uri>
5957 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5959 yes | yes | yes | no
5960 Arguments :
5961 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5962 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5963
5964 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5965 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5966 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5967 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5968 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5969 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5970 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5971 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5972
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005973 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5974 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5975 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5976 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5977 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5978 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5979 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5980 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005981
5982 Example :
5983 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5984 frontend www
5985 mode http
5986 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5987
5988 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005990
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005991option abortonclose
5992no option abortonclose
5993 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5995 yes | no | yes | yes
5996 Arguments : none
5997
5998 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5999 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6000 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6001 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006002 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006003 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6004 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6005 encountered while delivering the response.
6006
6007 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6008 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6009 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6010 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6011 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6012 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006013 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006014 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006015 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006016 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6017 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6018 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6019
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006020 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6021 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006022 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6023 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6024 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6025 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6026 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6027 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006028 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006029
6030 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6031 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6032
6033 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6034
6035
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006036option accept-invalid-http-request
6037no option accept-invalid-http-request
6038 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6040 yes | yes | yes | no
6041 Arguments : none
6042
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006043 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006044 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006045 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006046 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6047 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6048 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6049 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6050 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006051 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6052 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6053 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6054 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006055 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006056 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006057 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6058 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6059 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006060
6061 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6062 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6063 been confirmed.
6064
6065 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6066 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006067 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6068 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006069 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6070
6071 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6072 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6073
6074 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6075 stats socket.
6076
6077
6078option accept-invalid-http-response
6079no option accept-invalid-http-response
6080 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6082 yes | no | yes | yes
6083 Arguments : none
6084
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006085 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006086 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006087 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006088 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6089 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6090 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6091 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6092 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006093 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6094 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6095 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006096
6097 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6098 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6099 been confirmed.
6100
6101 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6102 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6103 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6104 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6105
6106 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6107 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6108
6109 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6110 stats socket.
6111
6112
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006113option allbackups
6114no option allbackups
6115 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6117 yes | no | yes | yes
6118 Arguments : none
6119
6120 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6121 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6122 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6123 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6124 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6125 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6126 order between the backup servers anymore.
6127
6128 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6129 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6130
6131 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6132 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6133
6134
6135option checkcache
6136no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006137 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6139 yes | no | yes | yes
6140 Arguments : none
6141
6142 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6143 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006144 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006145 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6146 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006147 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006148
6149 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006150 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006151 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006152 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6153 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006154 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006155 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006156 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6157 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006158 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006159 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6160 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006161 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006162 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6163 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6164 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6165 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6166 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6167 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6168 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6169 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6170 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6171
6172 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006173 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006174 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006175 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006176 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6177
6178 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6179 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006180 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006181 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006182
6183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6185
6186
6187option clitcpka
6188no option clitcpka
6189 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6191 yes | yes | yes | no
6192 Arguments : none
6193
6194 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6195 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006196 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006197 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6198
6199 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6200 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6201 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6202 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6203
6204 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6205 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6206 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6207 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6208 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6209
6210 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6211
6212 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6213 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6214 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6215
6216 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6217 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6218
6219 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6220
6221
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006222option contstats
6223 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6225 yes | yes | yes | no
6226 Arguments : none
6227
6228 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6229 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6230 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6231 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006232 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6233 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6234 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6235 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6236 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006237
6238
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006239option dontlog-normal
6240no option dontlog-normal
6241 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6243 yes | yes | yes | no
6244 Arguments : none
6245
6246 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6247 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6248 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6249 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6250 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6251 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6252 logged.
6253
6254 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6255 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6256 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006258 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006259 logging.
6260
6261
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006262option dontlognull
6263no option dontlognull
6264 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6266 yes | yes | yes | no
6267 Arguments : none
6268
6269 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6270 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6271 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6272 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6273 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6274 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006275 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6276 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6277 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006278
6279 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006280 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006281 would not be logged.
6282
6283 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6284 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6285
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006286 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6287 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006288
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006289
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006290option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006291 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 yes | yes | yes | yes
6294 Arguments :
6295 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6296 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006297 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006298 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006299
6300 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6301 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6302 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6303 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6304 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6305 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6306 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006307 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6308 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6309 possible that the client has already brought one.
6310
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006311 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006312 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006313 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006314 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006315 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006316 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006317
6318 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6319 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6320 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6321 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6322 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6323 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6324 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6325
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006326 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6327 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6328 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6329 are under the control of the end-user.
6330
Christopher Faulet313fa092021-04-06 09:01:09 +02006331 Only IPv4 addresses are supported. "http-request add-header" or "http-request
6332 set-header" rules may be used to work around this limitation.
6333
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006334 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006335 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6336 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006337 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6338 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6339 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006340
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006341 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006342 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6343 frontend www
6344 mode http
6345 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6346
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006347 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6348 backend www
6349 mode http
6350 option forwardfor header X-Client
6351
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006352 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006353 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006354
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006355
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006356option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6357no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6358 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6360 yes | yes | yes | no
6361 Arguments : none
6362
6363 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6364 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6365 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6366 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6367 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6368 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6369 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6370
6371 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6372 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6373 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6374 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6375 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6376 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6377 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6378 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6379 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6380 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6381
6382 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6383
6384 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6385 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6386
6387 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6388 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6389
6390
6391option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6392no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6393 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6395 yes | no | yes | yes
6396 Arguments : none
6397
6398 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6399 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6400 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6401 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6402 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6403 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6404 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6405
6406 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6407 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6408 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6409 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6410 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6411 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6412 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6413 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6414 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6415 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6416
6417 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6418
6419 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6420 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6421
6422 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6423 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6424
6425
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006426option http-buffer-request
6427no option http-buffer-request
6428 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 yes | yes | yes | yes
6431 Arguments : none
6432
6433 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6434 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6435 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6436 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6437 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6438 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6439 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6440 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006441 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006442 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6443 default.
6444
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006445 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006446
6447
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006448option http-ignore-probes
6449no option http-ignore-probes
6450 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6452 yes | yes | yes | no
6453 Arguments : none
6454
6455 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6456 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6457 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6458 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6459 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6460 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6461 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6462 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6463 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006464 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6465 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006466 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6467
6468 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6469 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6470 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6471 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6472 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6473 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6474 are often the only way to detect them.
6475
6476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6478
6479 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6480
6481
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006482option http-keep-alive
6483no option http-keep-alive
6484 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6486 yes | yes | yes | yes
6487 Arguments : none
6488
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006489 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6490 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006491 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6492 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6493 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6494 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6495 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006496
6497 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6498 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006499 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6500 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6501 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6502 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6503 situations where this option may be useful :
6504
6505 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006506 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006507
6508 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6509 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6510
6511 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6512 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6513 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6514 request.
6515
6516 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6517 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006518 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6519 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6520 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006521
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006522 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6523 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6524 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6525 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6526 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6527 not set.
6528
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006529 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006530 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6531 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006532
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006533 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006534 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006535 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006536
6537
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006538option http-no-delay
6539no option http-no-delay
6540 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6542 yes | yes | yes | yes
6543 Arguments : none
6544
6545 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6546 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6547 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6548 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6549 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6550 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6551 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6552 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6553 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6554 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6555 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6556 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6557 affected.
6558
6559 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6560 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6561 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6562 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6563 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6564 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6565 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6566 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6567 latency environments.
6568
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006569 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6570
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006571
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006572option http-pretend-keepalive
6573no option http-pretend-keepalive
6574 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006576 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006577 Arguments : none
6578
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006579 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006580 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6581 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6582 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6583 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6584 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6585 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6586 consider the response complete.
6587
6588 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6589 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6590 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6591 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006592 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006593 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6594
6595 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6596 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6597 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6598 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6599 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6600 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6601 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6602
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006603 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6604 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6605 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6606 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6607 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6608 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006609
6610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6612
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006613 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006614 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006615
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006616
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006617option http-server-close
6618no option http-server-close
6619 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6621 yes | yes | yes | yes
6622 Arguments : none
6623
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006624 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6625 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6626 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6627 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006628 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6629 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6630 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6631 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6632 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6633 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6634 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6635 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6636 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6637 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6638 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006639
6640 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6641 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6642 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6643 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006644 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6645 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006646
6647 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6648 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006649 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6650 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6651 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006652
6653 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6654 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6655
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006656 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6657 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006658
6659
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006660option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6661no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6662 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006664 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006665 Arguments : none
6666
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006667 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6668 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6669 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6670
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006671 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6672 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6673 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6674 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006675 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006676
6677 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006678 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006679 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6680 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6681 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6682 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6683 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6684 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6685 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006686
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006687 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6688 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6689 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6690 backend.
6691
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006692 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6693 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6694
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006695 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6696 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006697
6698
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006699option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006700no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006701 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6703 yes | yes | yes | no
6704 Arguments : none
6705
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006706 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006707 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6708 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6709 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6710 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6711 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6712 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6713
6714 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6715 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006716 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6717 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6718 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006719
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006720 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6721 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6722 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6723 front of an existing proxy.
6724
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006725 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6726
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006727 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006728
6729
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006730option http-use-htx
6731no option http-use-htx
6732 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6734 yes | yes | yes | yes
6735 Arguments : none
6736
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006737 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006738 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006739 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6740 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6741 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6742 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6743 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006744
6745 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6746 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6747 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6748 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006749 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6750 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6751 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6752 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006753
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006754 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6755 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6756 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6757 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6758 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006759
6760 See also : "mode http"
6761
6762
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006763option httpchk
6764option httpchk <uri>
6765option httpchk <method> <uri>
6766option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6767 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6769 yes | no | yes | yes
6770 Arguments :
6771 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6772 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6773 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6774 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6775 ones.
6776
6777 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6778 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6779 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6780
6781 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6782 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6783 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006784 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006785
6786 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6787 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6788 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6789 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6790 the lack of any response.
6791
6792 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6793
6794 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6795 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6796 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6797
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006798 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
6799 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
6800 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
6801 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
6802
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006803 Examples :
6804 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6805 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6806 backend https_relay
6807 mode tcp
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006808 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
6809 http-check send hdr Host www
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006810 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6811
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006812 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6813 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6814 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006815
6816
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006817option httpclose
6818no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006819 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6821 yes | yes | yes | yes
6822 Arguments : none
6823
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006824 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6825 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6826 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6827 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006828 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006829
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006830 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6831 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006832 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006833 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6834 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006835
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006836 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6837 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6838 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006839
6840 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6841 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006842 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006843 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6844 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6845 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006846
6847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6849
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006850 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006851
6852
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006853option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006854 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006856 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006857 Arguments :
6858 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6859 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6860 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006861 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006862 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006863
6864 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6865 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6866 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6867 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6868 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6869 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6870 ports.
6871
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006872 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6873 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006874
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006875 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006877 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006878
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006879
6880option http_proxy
6881no option http_proxy
6882 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6884 yes | yes | yes | yes
6885 Arguments : none
6886
6887 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6888 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6889 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6890 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6891 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6892
6893 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6894 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006895 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6896 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006897
6898 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6899 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6900
6901 Example :
6902 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6903 backend direct_forward
6904 option httpclose
6905 option http_proxy
6906
6907 See also : "option httpclose"
6908
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006909
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006910option independent-streams
6911no option independent-streams
6912 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6914 yes | yes | yes | yes
6915 Arguments : none
6916
6917 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6918 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6919 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6920 receive data or not.
6921
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006922 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006923 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6924 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6925 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6926 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6927 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6928 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6929 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6930 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6931 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6932 socket buffers.
6933
6934 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6935 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6936 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6937 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6938 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6939
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006940 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006941 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6942 deprecated.
6943
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006944 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006945
6946
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006947option ldap-check
6948 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | no | yes | yes
6951 Arguments : none
6952
6953 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6954 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6955 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6956 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6957
6958 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6959 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6960
6961 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6962 configure it.
6963
6964 Example :
6965 option ldap-check
6966
6967 See also : "option httpchk"
6968
6969
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006970option external-check
6971 Use external processes for server health checks
6972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6973 yes | no | yes | yes
6974
6975 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6976 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6977 command".
6978
6979 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6980
6981 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6982
6983
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006984option log-health-checks
6985no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006986 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6988 yes | no | yes | yes
6989 Arguments : none
6990
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006991 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6992 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6993 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006994
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006995 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6996 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6997 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6998 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6999 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7000
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007001 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007002 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007003
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007004 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7005 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7006 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007007
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007008
7009option log-separate-errors
7010no option log-separate-errors
7011 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7013 yes | yes | yes | no
7014 Arguments : none
7015
7016 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7017 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7018 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7019 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7020 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7021 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7022 provides very important information.
7023
7024 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7025 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7026 error logs.
7027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007028 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007029 logging.
7030
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007031
7032option logasap
7033no option logasap
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007034 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 yes | yes | yes | no
7037 Arguments : none
7038
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007039 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7040 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7041 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7042 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7043
7044 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7045 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7046 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7047 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7048 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7049 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7050 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7051 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7052 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7053 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7054 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007055
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007056 Examples :
7057 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7058 mode http
7059 option httplog
7060 option logasap
7061 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7062
7063 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7064 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7065 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7066 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007068 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007069 logging.
7070
7071
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007072option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007073 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7075 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007076 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007077 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7078 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007079 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007080
7081 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7082 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007083 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007084 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackcc690342021-07-01 12:09:32 +10007085 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
7086 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
7087 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007088
Daniel Blackcc690342021-07-01 12:09:32 +10007089 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
7090 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
7091 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007092
7093 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007094 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007095 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7096 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7097 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7098 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7099 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7100 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7101 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7102
7103 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7104 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007105
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007106 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007107
7108 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7109 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7110 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7111 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007112 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7113 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007114
7115 See also: "option httpchk"
7116
7117
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007118option nolinger
7119no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007120 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007121 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7122 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007123 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007124
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007125 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007126 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7127 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7128 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7129 connections.
7130
7131 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7132 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7133 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7134 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7135 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7136 this too.
7137
7138 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7139 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7140 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7141
7142 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7143 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7144 for servers.
7145
7146 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7147 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7148
7149
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007150option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7151 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7153 yes | yes | yes | yes
7154 Arguments :
7155 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7156 matching <network>
7157 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7158 header name.
7159
7160 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7161 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7162 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7163 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7164 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7165 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7166 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7167 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7168 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7169 possible that the client has already brought one.
7170
7171 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7172 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7173 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7174 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7175 header and requires different one.
7176
7177 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7178 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7179 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7180 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7181 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7182 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7183 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7184
Christopher Faulet313fa092021-04-06 09:01:09 +02007185 Only IPv4 addresses are supported. "http-request add-header" or "http-request
7186 set-header" rules may be used to work around this limitation.
7187
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007188 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7189 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7190 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7191 both are defined.
7192
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007193 Examples :
7194 # Original Destination address
7195 frontend www
7196 mode http
7197 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7198
7199 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7200 backend www
7201 mode http
7202 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007204 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007205
7206
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007207option persist
7208no option persist
7209 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7210 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7211 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007212 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007213
7214 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7215 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7216 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7217 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7218 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7219 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7220 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7221 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7222 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7223 redirected to another valid server.
7224
7225 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7226 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7227
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007228 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007229
7230
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007231option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7232 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7234 yes | no | yes | yes
7235 Arguments :
7236 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7237 PostgreSQL server.
7238
7239 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7240 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7241 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7242 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7243
7244 See also: "option httpchk"
7245
7246
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007247option prefer-last-server
7248no option prefer-last-server
7249 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7250 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7251 yes | no | yes | yes
7252 Arguments : none
7253
7254 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7255 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7256 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7257 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7258 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7259 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7260 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7261 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7262 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007263 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7264 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007265 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7266 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7267 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007268 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7269 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7270 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007271
7272 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7273 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7274
7275 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7276
7277
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007278option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007279option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007280no option redispatch
7281 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7283 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007284 Arguments :
7285 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7286 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7287 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007288 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007289 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007290 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007291 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7292 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7293 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007295
7296 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7297 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7298 be able to access the service anymore.
7299
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007300 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7301 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007302
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007303 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007304 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7305 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007307 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7308 "redisp" keywords.
7309
7310 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7311 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7312
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007313 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007314
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007315
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007316option redis-check
7317 Use redis health checks for server testing
7318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7319 yes | no | yes | yes
7320 Arguments : none
7321
7322 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7323 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7324 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7325 find the "+PONG" response message.
7326
7327 Example :
7328 option redis-check
7329
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007330 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007331
7332
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007333option smtpchk
7334option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7335 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7337 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007338 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007339 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007340 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007341 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7342
7343 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7344 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7345 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7346
7347 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7348 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7349 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7350 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7351 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7352 dead server.
7353
7354 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7355 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007356 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007357 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7358
7359 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7360 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7361 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7362 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007363 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007364
7365 Example :
7366 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7367
7368 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007371option socket-stats
7372no option socket-stats
7373
7374 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7376 yes | yes | yes | no
7377
7378 Arguments : none
7379
7380
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007381option splice-auto
7382no option splice-auto
7383 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7385 yes | yes | yes | yes
7386 Arguments : none
7387
7388 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7389 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007390 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007391 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007392 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007393 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7394 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7395 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7396 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7397
7398 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7399 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7400 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7401 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7402 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7403 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7404 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7405 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7406 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7407 keyword.
7408
7409 Example :
7410 option splice-auto
7411
7412 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7413 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7414
7415 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7416 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7417
7418
7419option splice-request
7420no option splice-request
7421 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7423 yes | yes | yes | yes
7424 Arguments : none
7425
7426 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007427 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007428 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7429 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7430 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7431 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7432
7433 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7434
7435 Example :
7436 option splice-request
7437
7438 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7439 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7440
7441 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7442 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7443
7444
7445option splice-response
7446no option splice-response
7447 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7449 yes | yes | yes | yes
7450 Arguments : none
7451
7452 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007453 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007454 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7455 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7456 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7457 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7458
7459 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7460
7461 Example :
7462 option splice-response
7463
7464 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7465 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7466
7467 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7468 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7469
7470
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007471option spop-check
7472 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7474 no | no | no | yes
7475 Arguments : none
7476
7477 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7478 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7479 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7480 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7481
7482 Example :
7483 option spop-check
7484
7485 See also : "option httpchk"
7486
7487
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007488option srvtcpka
7489no option srvtcpka
7490 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7492 yes | no | yes | yes
7493 Arguments : none
7494
7495 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7496 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007497 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007498 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7499
7500 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7501 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7502 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7503 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7504
7505 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7506 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7507 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7508 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7509 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7510
7511 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7512
7513 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7514 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7515 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7516
7517 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7518 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7519
7520 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7521
7522
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007523option ssl-hello-chk
7524 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7526 yes | no | yes | yes
7527 Arguments : none
7528
7529 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7530 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7531 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7532 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7533 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7534 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7535 hello message.
7536
7537 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7538 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7539 messages, which is appreciable.
7540
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007541 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7542 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7543 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007544
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007545 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7546
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007547
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007548option tcp-check
7549 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7550 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7551 yes | no | yes | yes
7552
7553 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7554 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7555
7556 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7557 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7558 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7559
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007560 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007561 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7562 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7563 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7564 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7565 only.
7566
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007567 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007568 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7569 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7570 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7571 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7572
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007573 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007574 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7575 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007576 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007577 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7578 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7579 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7580 the respective protocols.
7581 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007582 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007583
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007584 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7585 script.
7586
7587 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7588 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7589 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7590 The "comment" is of course optional.
7591
7592
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007593 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007594 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007595 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007596 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007597
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007598 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007599 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007600 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007601
7602 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7603 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007604 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007605 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007606 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007607 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007608 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007609 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007610 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7611 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007612 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007613 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7614 tcp-check expect string +OK
7615
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007616 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007617 (send many headers before analyzing)
7618 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007619 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007620 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7621 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7622 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7623 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007624 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007625
7626
7627 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7628
7629
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007630option tcp-smart-accept
7631no option tcp-smart-accept
7632 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7634 yes | yes | yes | no
7635 Arguments : none
7636
7637 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7638 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7639 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7640 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7641 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7642 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7643
7644 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7645 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7646 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7647 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7648
7649 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7650 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7651 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007652 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007653
7654 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7655 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7656 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7657
7658 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7659 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7660 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7661
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007662 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7663
7664
7665option tcp-smart-connect
7666no option tcp-smart-connect
7667 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7669 yes | no | yes | yes
7670 Arguments : none
7671
7672 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7673 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7674 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7675 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7676 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7677
7678 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7679 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7680 complex.
7681
7682 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7683 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7684 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7685
7686 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7687 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7688
7689 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7690
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007691
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007692option tcpka
7693 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7695 yes | yes | yes | yes
7696 Arguments : none
7697
7698 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7699 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007700 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007701 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7702
7703 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7704 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7705 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7706 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7707
7708 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7709 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7710 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7711 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7712 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7713
7714 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7715
7716 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7717 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7718 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7719 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7720 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7721 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7722 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7723 backends.
7724
7725 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7726
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007727
7728option tcplog
7729 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007731 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007732 Arguments : none
7733
7734 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7735 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7736 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7737 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7738 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7739 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7740 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7741 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7742
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007743 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007745 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007746
7747
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007748option transparent
7749no option transparent
7750 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007752 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007753 Arguments : none
7754
7755 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7756 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7757 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7758 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7759 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7760 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7761 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7762 appropriate server.
7763
7764 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7765 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7766
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007767 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007768 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007769
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007770
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007771external-check command <command>
7772 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7774 yes | no | yes | yes
7775
7776 Arguments :
7777 <command> is the external command to run
7778
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007779 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7780
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007781 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007782
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007783 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7784 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7785 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7786 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7787 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7788 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007789
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007790 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7791
7792 Environment variables :
7793 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7794 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7795
7796 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7797
7798 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7799
7800 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7801 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7802 for a UNIX socket).
7803
7804 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7805
7806 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7807
7808 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7809
7810 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7811
7812 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7813
7814 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7815 socket).
7816
7817 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7818 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7819
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007820 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7821
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007822 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7823 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7824 failed.
7825
7826 Example :
7827 external-check command /bin/true
7828
7829 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7830
7831
7832external-check path <path>
7833 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7835 yes | no | yes | yes
7836
7837 Arguments :
7838 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7839
7840 The default path is "".
7841
7842 Example :
7843 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7844
7845 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7846 "external-check command"
7847
7848
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007849persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007850persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007851 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7853 yes | no | yes | yes
7854 Arguments :
7855 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007856 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7857 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007858
7859 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7860 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007861 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007862 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7863 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7864 forwarded to this server.
7865
7866 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7867 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7868 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007869 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007870 a single "listen" section.
7871
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007872 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7873 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7874 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7875
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007876 Example :
7877 listen tse-farm
7878 bind :3389
7879 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7880 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7881 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7882 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7883 persist rdp-cookie
7884 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007885 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007886 balance rdp-cookie
7887 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7888 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7889
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007890 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7891 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007892
7893
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007894rate-limit sessions <rate>
7895 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7897 yes | yes | yes | no
7898 Arguments :
7899 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7900 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7901
7902 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7903 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7904 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7905 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7906 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7907 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7908
7909 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7910 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7911 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7912 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7913
7914 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7915 listen smtp
7916 mode tcp
7917 bind :25
7918 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007919 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007920
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007921 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7922 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7923 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007924
7925 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7926
7927
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007928redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7929redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7930redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007931 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7933 no | yes | yes | yes
7934
7935 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007936 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007937
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007938 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007939 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007940 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7941 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7942 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007943
7944 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7945 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7946 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7947 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7948 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007949 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7950 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7951 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7952 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007953
7954 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7955 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7956 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7957 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7958 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7959 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007960 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007961 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007962 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7963 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7964 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007965
7966 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007967 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7968 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7969 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007970 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007971 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7972 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7973 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7974 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007975
7976 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007977 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007978
7979 - "drop-query"
7980 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7981 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7982 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7983 with a location-type redirect.
7984
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007985 - "append-slash"
7986 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7987 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7988 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7989 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7990
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007991 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7992 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7993 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7994 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7995 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7996 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7997 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7998
7999 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8000 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8001 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8002 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8003 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8004 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8005 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008006
8007 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8008 acl clear dst_port 80
8009 acl secure dst_port 8080
8010 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008011 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008012 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008013 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8014
8015 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008016 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8017 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8018 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008019 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008020
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008021 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8022 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8023 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8024
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008025 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008026 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008027
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008028 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008029 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8030 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8031 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008033 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008034
8035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008036redisp (deprecated)
8037redispatch (deprecated)
8038 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8039 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8040 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008041 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008042
8043 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8044 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8045 be able to access the service anymore.
8046
8047 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
8048 redistribute them to a working server.
8049
8050 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
8051 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8052 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008054 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
8055 "option redispatch" instead.
8056
8057 See also : "option redispatch"
8058
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008059
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008060reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008061 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
8062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8063 no | yes | yes | yes
8064 Arguments :
8065 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8066 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008067 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008068
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008069 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8070 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8071
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008072 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8073 the last header of an HTTP request.
8074
8075 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8076 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8077 responses.
8078
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008079 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
8080 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
8081 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
8082
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008083 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
8084 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008085
8086
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008087reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8088reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008089 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8091 no | yes | yes | yes
8092 Arguments :
8093 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8094 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8095 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8096 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8097 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8098 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8099 ignores case.
8100
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008101 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8102 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8103
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008104 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8105 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8106 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8107 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008108 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008109
8110 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8111 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8112
8113 Example :
8114 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8115 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8116 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8117
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008118 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8119 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008120
8121
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008122reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8123reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008124 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8126 no | yes | yes | yes
8127 Arguments :
8128 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8129 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8130 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8131 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8132 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8133 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8134
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008135 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8136 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8137
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008138 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8139 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8140 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8141 next servers.
8142
8143 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8144 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8145 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8146
8147 Example :
8148 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8149 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8150 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8151
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008152 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8153 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008154
8155
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008156reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8157reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008158 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8160 no | yes | yes | yes
8161 Arguments :
8162 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8163 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8164 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8165 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8166 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8167 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8168 case.
8169
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008170 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8171 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8172
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008173 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8174 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8175 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8176 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008177 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008178
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008179 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008180 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008181 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008182
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008183 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8184 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8185
8186 Example :
8187 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8188 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8189 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8190
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008191 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8192 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008193
8194
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008195reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8196reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008197 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8199 no | yes | yes | yes
8200 Arguments :
8201 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8202 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8203 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8204 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8205 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8206 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8207 case.
8208
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008209 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8210 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8211
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008212 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8213 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8214 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8215 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8216
8217 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8218 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8219
8220 Example :
8221 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8222 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8223 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8224 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8225
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008226 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8227 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008228
8229
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008230reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8231reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008232 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8234 no | yes | yes | yes
8235 Arguments :
8236 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8237 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8238 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8239 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8240 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8241 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8242
8243 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8244 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8245 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8246 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008247 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008248
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008249 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8250 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8251
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008252 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8253 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8254 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8255
8256 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8257 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8258 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8259 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8260 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8261
8262 Example :
8263 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008264 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008265 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8266 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8267
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008268 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8269 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008270
8271
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008272reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8273reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008274 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8276 no | yes | yes | yes
8277 Arguments :
8278 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8279 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8280 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8281 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8282 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8283 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8284 ignores case.
8285
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008286 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8287 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8288
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008289 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8290 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008291 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8292 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8293 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008294 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8295 not set.
8296
8297 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8298 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8299 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8300 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8301 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8302
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008303 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008304 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008305 # block all others.
8306 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8307 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8308
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008309 # block bad guys
8310 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8311 reqitarpit . if badguys
8312
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008313 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8314 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008315
8316
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008317retries <value>
8318 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8320 yes | no | yes | yes
8321 Arguments :
8322 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8323 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8324 default value is 3.
8325
8326 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8327 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8328 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8329
8330 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008331 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8332 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008333
8334 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8335 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8336
8337 See also : "option redispatch"
8338
8339
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008340retry-on [list of keywords]
8341 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8342 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8343 yes | no | yes | yes
8344 Arguments :
8345 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8346 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8347 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8348 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8349
8350 none never retry
8351
8352 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8353 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8354
8355 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8356 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8357 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8358 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8359 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8360 processing the request.
8361
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008362 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8363 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8364 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8365 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8366 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8367 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8368 overflow attack for example).
8369
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008370 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8371 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8372 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8373 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8374 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8375 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8376 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8377 amplify denial of service attacks.
8378
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008379 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8380 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8381 considered to be safe to retry.
8382
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008383 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8384 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8385 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8386 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8387
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008388 all-retryable-errors
8389 retry request for any error that are considered
8390 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8391 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8392 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8393
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008394 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8395 not cumulative.
8396
8397 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8398 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8399 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8400 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8401
8402 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8403 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8404 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8405 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8406 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8407 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8408 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8409 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8410 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8411 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8412 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8413 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8414
8415 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8416 should not use this directive.
8417
8418 The default is "conn-failure".
8419
8420 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8421
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008422rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008423 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8425 no | yes | yes | yes
8426 Arguments :
8427 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8428 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008429 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008430
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008431 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8432 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8433
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008434 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8435 the last header of an HTTP response.
8436
8437 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8438 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8439 responses.
8440
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008441 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8442 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008443
8444
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008445rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8446rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008447 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8449 no | yes | yes | yes
8450 Arguments :
8451 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8452 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8453 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8454 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8455 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8456 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8457 ignores case.
8458
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008459 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8460 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8461
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008462 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8463 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008464 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008465 client.
8466
8467 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8468 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8469 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8470
8471 Example :
8472 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008473 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008474
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008475 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8476 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008477
8478
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008479rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8480rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008481 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8483 no | yes | yes | yes
8484 Arguments :
8485 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8486 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8487 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8488 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8489 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8490 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8491 ignores case.
8492
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008493 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8494 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8495
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008496 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8497 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8498 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8499 case-sensitive.
8500
8501 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008502 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8503 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8504 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008505
8506 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8507 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8508
8509 Example :
8510 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8511 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8512
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008513 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8514 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008515
8516
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008517rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8518rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008519 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8521 no | yes | yes | yes
8522 Arguments :
8523 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8524 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8525 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8526 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8527 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8528 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8529 ignores case.
8530
8531 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8532 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8533 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8534 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008535 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008536
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008537 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8538 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8539
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008540 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8541 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8542 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8543
8544 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8545 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8546 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8547 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8548 are not case-sensitive.
8549
8550 Example :
8551 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8552 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8553
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008554 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8555 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008556
8557
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008558server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008559 Declare a server in a backend
8560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8561 no | no | yes | yes
8562 Arguments :
8563 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008564 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008565 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008566
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008567 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8568 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8569 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8570 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008571 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8572 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8573 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8574 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8575 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008576 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8577 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8578 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8579 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8580 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8581 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8582 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008583 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008584 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8585 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8586 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8587 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8588 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8589 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008590 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8591 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008592 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8593 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008594
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008595 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008596 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8597 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8598 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8599 adding this value to the client's port.
8600
8601 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8602 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008603 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008604
8605 Examples :
8606 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8607 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008608 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008609 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8610 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8611 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008612
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008613 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8614 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8615 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8616 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8617 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8618
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008619 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8620 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008621
Christopher Fauletea1300f2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01008622server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008623 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Fauletea1300f2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01008624 this backend.
8625 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8626 no | no | yes | yes
8627
8628 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
8629 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
8630 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
8631 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
8632 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008633
8634 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8635 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8636
8637 global
8638 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8639
Willy Tarreau750bb0c2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008640 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008641 load-server-state-from-file
8642
Christopher Fauletea1300f2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01008643 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008644 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008645
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008646server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8647 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8648 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8650 no | no | yes | yes
8651
8652 Arguments:
8653 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8654
8655 <num | range>
8656 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8657 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8658 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8659 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8660
8661 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8662
8663 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8664
8665 <params*>
8666 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8667 keyword.
8668
8669 Examples:
8670 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8671 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8672 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8673
8674 # or
8675 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8676
8677 # would be equivalent to:
8678 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8679 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8680 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8681
8682
8683
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008684source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008685source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008686source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008687 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8689 yes | no | yes | yes
8690 Arguments :
8691 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8692 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008693
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008694 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008695 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8696 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8697 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8698 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8699 supported prefixes are :
8700 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8701 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8702 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008703 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008704 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8705 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008706
8707 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8708 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008709 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8710 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8711 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008712
8713 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8714 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8715 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8716 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8717 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8718 <addr>.
8719
8720 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8721 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8722 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8723 port.
8724
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008725 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8726 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8727 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8728 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008729 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008730 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8731 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8732 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8733 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8734 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8735 HTTP header.
8736
8737 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8738 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008739 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008740 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8741 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8742 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8743 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8744 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8745 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8746 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8747
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008748 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8749 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8750 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8751 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8752 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8753 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8754
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008755 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8756 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8757 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8758 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8759
8760 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8761 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8762 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8763 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8764 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8765 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8766
8767 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8768 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8769 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8770 there are two methods :
8771
8772 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8773 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8774 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8775 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8776 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8777 of the client ranges may be used.
8778
8779 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8780 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8781 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8782 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8783 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8784 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8785 same session.
8786
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008787 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8788 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8789 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008790 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008791
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008792 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8793
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008794 Examples :
8795 backend private
8796 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8797 source 192.168.1.200
8798
8799 backend transparent_ssl1
8800 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8801 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8802
8803 backend transparent_ssl2
8804 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8805 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8806 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8807
8808 backend transparent_ssl3
8809 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8810 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8811 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8812
8813 backend transparent_smtp
8814 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8815 # with Tproxy version 4.
8816 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8817
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008818 backend transparent_http
8819 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8820 # proxy.
8821 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008823 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008824 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008826
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008827srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8828 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8830 yes | no | yes | yes
8831 Arguments :
8832 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8833 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8834 as explained at the top of this document.
8835
8836 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8837 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8838 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8839 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8840 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8841 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8842 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8843
8844 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8845 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8846 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8847 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8848 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008849 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008850 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008851 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008852
8853 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8854 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8855 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8856 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8857 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8858 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8859
8860 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8861 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8862
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008863 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8864 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008865
8866
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008867stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8868 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008870 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008871
8872 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8873 matched.
8874
8875 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8876 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8877
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008878 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8879 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008880 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008881
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008882 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8883 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8884 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8885 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008886
8887 Example :
8888 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8889 backend stats_localhost
8890 stats enable
8891 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8892
8893 Example :
8894 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8895 backend stats_auth
8896 stats enable
8897 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8898 stats admin if TRUE
8899
8900 Example :
8901 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8902 userlist stats-auth
8903 group admin users admin
8904 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8905 group readonly users haproxy
8906 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8907
8908 backend stats_auth
8909 stats enable
8910 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8911 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8912 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8913 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8914
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008915 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8916 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8917 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008918
8919
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008920stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8921 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008923 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008924 Arguments :
8925 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8926
8927 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8928
8929 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8930 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8931 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8932 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8933 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8934 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8935
8936 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8937 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8938 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008939 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008940
8941 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8942 report using "stats scope".
8943
8944 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8945 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8946 unobvious parameters.
8947
8948 Example :
8949 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8950 backend public_www
8951 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8952 stats enable
8953 stats hide-version
8954 stats scope .
8955 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008956 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008957 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8958 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8959
8960 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8961 backend private_monitoring
8962 stats enable
8963 stats uri /admin?stats
8964 stats refresh 5s
8965
8966 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8967
8968
8969stats enable
8970 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008972 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008973 Arguments : none
8974
8975 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8976 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8977 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8978 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8979 - stats auth : no authentication
8980 - stats scope : no restriction
8981
8982 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8983 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8984 unobvious parameters.
8985
8986 Example :
8987 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8988 backend public_www
8989 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8990 stats enable
8991 stats hide-version
8992 stats scope .
8993 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008994 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008995 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8996 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8997
8998 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8999 backend private_monitoring
9000 stats enable
9001 stats uri /admin?stats
9002 stats refresh 5s
9003
9004 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9005
9006
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009007stats hide-version
9008 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009010 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009011 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009012
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009013 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9014 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9015 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9016 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9017 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9018 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009020 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9021 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9022 unobvious parameters.
9023
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009024 Example :
9025 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9026 backend public_www
9027 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009028 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009029 stats hide-version
9030 stats scope .
9031 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009032 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009033 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9034 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009035
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009036 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9037 backend private_monitoring
9038 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009039 stats uri /admin?stats
9040 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009041
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009042 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009043
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009044
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009045stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9046 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9047 Access control for statistics
9048
9049 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9050 no | no | yes | yes
9051
9052 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9053 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9054 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9055 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9056 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9057 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9058
9059 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9060 instance.
9061
9062 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9063 about ACL usage.
9064
9065
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009066stats realm <realm>
9067 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009069 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009070 Arguments :
9071 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9072 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9073 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9074
9075 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9076 using a backslash ('\').
9077
9078 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9079 only related to authentication.
9080
9081 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9082 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9083 unobvious parameters.
9084
9085 Example :
9086 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9087 backend public_www
9088 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9089 stats enable
9090 stats hide-version
9091 stats scope .
9092 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009093 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009094 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9095 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9096
9097 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9098 backend private_monitoring
9099 stats enable
9100 stats uri /admin?stats
9101 stats refresh 5s
9102
9103 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9104
9105
9106stats refresh <delay>
9107 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009109 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009110 Arguments :
9111 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9112 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9113 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9114 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9115 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9116 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9117
9118 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9119 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9120 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9121 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9122
9123 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9124 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9125 unobvious parameters.
9126
9127 Example :
9128 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9129 backend public_www
9130 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9131 stats enable
9132 stats hide-version
9133 stats scope .
9134 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009135 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009136 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9137 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9138
9139 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9140 backend private_monitoring
9141 stats enable
9142 stats uri /admin?stats
9143 stats refresh 5s
9144
9145 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9146
9147
9148stats scope { <name> | "." }
9149 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009151 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009152 Arguments :
9153 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9154 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9155 section in which the statement appears.
9156
9157 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9158 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9159 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9160 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9161 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9162 exists.
9163
9164 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9165 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9166 unobvious parameters.
9167
9168 Example :
9169 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9170 backend public_www
9171 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9172 stats enable
9173 stats hide-version
9174 stats scope .
9175 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009176 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009177 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9178 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9179
9180 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9181 backend private_monitoring
9182 stats enable
9183 stats uri /admin?stats
9184 stats refresh 5s
9185
9186 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9187
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009188
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009189stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009190 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009192 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009193
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009194 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009195 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9196
9197 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9198 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9199
9200 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9201 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009202 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009203
9204 Example :
9205 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9206 backend private_monitoring
9207 stats enable
9208 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9209 stats uri /admin?stats
9210 stats refresh 5s
9211
9212 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9213 global section.
9214
9215
9216stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009217 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9219 yes | yes | yes | yes
9220 Arguments : none
9221
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009222 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009223 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9224 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9225 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9226 - IP (socket, server)
9227 - cookie (backend, server)
9228
9229 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9230 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009231 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009232
9233 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9234
9235
9236stats show-node [ <name> ]
9237 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009239 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009240 Arguments:
9241 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9242 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9243
9244 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9245 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009246 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009247
9248 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9249 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9250 unobvious parameters.
9251
9252 Example:
9253 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9254 backend private_monitoring
9255 stats enable
9256 stats show-node Europe-1
9257 stats uri /admin?stats
9258 stats refresh 5s
9259
9260 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9261 section.
9262
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009263
9264stats uri <prefix>
9265 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009267 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009268 Arguments :
9269 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9270 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9271 query string.
9272
9273 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9274 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9275 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9276 possible to reach it in the application.
9277
9278 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009279 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009280 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9281 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9282 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9283 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9284
9285 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9286 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9287 an address or a port to statistics only.
9288
9289 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9290 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9291 unobvious parameters.
9292
9293 Example :
9294 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9295 backend public_www
9296 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9297 stats enable
9298 stats hide-version
9299 stats scope .
9300 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009301 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009302 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9303 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9304
9305 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9306 backend private_monitoring
9307 stats enable
9308 stats uri /admin?stats
9309 stats refresh 5s
9310
9311 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9312
9313
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009314stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9315 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009317 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009318
9319 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009320 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009321 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009322 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009323 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9324
9325 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9326 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9327 the "stick-table" statement.
9328
9329 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9330 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9331 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9332 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9333 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9334
9335 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9336 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9337 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9338 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9339 transformation rules.
9340
9341 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9342 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9343 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9344 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9345 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9346 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9347 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9348
9349 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9350 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9351 ACL based conditions.
9352
9353 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9354 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9355 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9356 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9357
9358 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9359 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9360 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9361 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9362
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009363 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9364 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009365 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009366
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009367 Example :
9368 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9369 # last 30 minutes
9370 backend pop
9371 mode tcp
9372 balance roundrobin
9373 stick store-request src
9374 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9375 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9376 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9377
9378 backend smtp
9379 mode tcp
9380 balance roundrobin
9381 stick match src table pop
9382 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9383 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9384
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009385 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009386 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009387
9388
9389stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9390 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9392 no | no | yes | yes
9393
9394 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9395 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9396 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9397 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9398
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009399 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9400 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009401 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009402
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009403 Examples :
9404 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009405 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009406
9407 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9408 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9409 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9410
9411
9412 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9413 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9414 backend http
9415 mode http
9416 balance roundrobin
9417 stick on src table https
9418 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9419 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9420 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9421
9422 backend https
9423 mode tcp
9424 balance roundrobin
9425 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9426 stick on src
9427 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9428 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9429
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009430 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009431
9432
9433stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9434 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9436 no | no | yes | yes
9437
9438 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009439 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009440 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009441 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009442 server is selected.
9443
9444 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9445 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9446 the "stick-table" statement.
9447
9448 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9449 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9450 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9451 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9452 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9453 address.
9454
9455 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9456 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9457 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9458 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9459 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9460 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9461 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9462 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9463 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9464 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9465
9466 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9467 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9468 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9469 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9470 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9471 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9472 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9473
9474 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9475 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9476 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9477 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9478
9479 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9480 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9481 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9482 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9483 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9484 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009485 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9486 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9487 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9488 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9489 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9490 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009491
9492 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9493 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9494 the request.
9495
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009496 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9497 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009498 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009499
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009500 Example :
9501 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9502 # last 30 minutes
9503 backend pop
9504 mode tcp
9505 balance roundrobin
9506 stick store-request src
9507 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9508 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9509 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9510
9511 backend smtp
9512 mode tcp
9513 balance roundrobin
9514 stick match src table pop
9515 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9516 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9517
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009518 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009519 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009520
9521
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009522stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009523 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9524 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009525 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009527 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009528
9529 Arguments :
9530 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9531 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9532 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9533 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9534
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009535 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9536 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9537 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9538 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9539
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009540 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9541 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9542 instance.
9543
9544 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9545 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9546 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9547 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9548 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9549 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009550 to 32 characters.
9551
9552 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9553 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9554 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009555 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009556 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9557 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009558
9559 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009560 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9561 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009562 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9563 increase.
9564
9565 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009566 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9567 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9568 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009569
9570 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9571 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9572 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9573 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009574 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009575 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9576 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9577 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9578 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9579 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9580 parameter (see below).
9581
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009582 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9583 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9584 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9585 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9586 soft restart.
9587
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009588 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9589 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009590
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009591 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9592 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9593 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9594 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009595 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009596 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009597 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9598 if not expiration delay is specified.
9599
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009600 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9601 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9602 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9603 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009604 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9605 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9606 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9607 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9608 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9609 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9610 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9611 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9612 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9613 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9614 types and their arguments.
9615
9616 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9617 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9618 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9619 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9620
9621 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9622 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9623 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009624 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009625
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009626 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9627 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9628 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009629 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009630 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009631 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009632
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009633 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9634 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9635 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9636 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9637
9638 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9639 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9640 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9641 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9642 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9643 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9644
Emeric Brunf143ccf2021-07-01 18:34:48 +02009645 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9646 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9647 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9648 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
9649
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009650 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9651 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9652 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9653 they were received.
9654
9655 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9656 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9657 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9658 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9659 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9660
9661 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9662 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9663 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9664 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9665 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9666
9667 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9668 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9669 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9670
9671 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9672 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9673 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9674 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9675 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9676
9677 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9678 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9679 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9680 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9681 the client side.
9682
9683 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9684 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9685 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9686 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9687 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9688 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9689 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9690
9691 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9692 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9693 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9694 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9695 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9696 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009697 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009698
9699 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9700 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9701 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9702 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9703 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9704 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9705
9706 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009707 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009708 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9709 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9710
9711 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9712 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9713 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9714 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9715 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9716 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9717 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9718 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9719 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9720 recommended for better fairness.
9721
9722 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009723 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009724 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9725 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9726
9727 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9728 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9729 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9730 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9731 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9732 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9733 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9734 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9735 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9736 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009737
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009738 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9739 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009740 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9741 reference it.
9742
9743 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9744 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009745 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9746 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9747 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009748
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009749 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9750 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9751 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9752 something that can be ignored.
9753
9754 Example:
9755 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9756 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9757 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9758 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9759
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009760 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009761 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009762
9763
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009764stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009765 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9767 no | no | yes | yes
9768
9769 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009770 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009771 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009772 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009773 server is selected.
9774
9775 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9776 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9777 the "stick-table" statement.
9778
9779 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9780 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9781 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9782 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9783
9784 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9785 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9786 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9787 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9788 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9789 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009790 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009791 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9792 rules.
9793
9794 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9795 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9796 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9797 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9798 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9799 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9800 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9801
9802 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9803 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9804 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9805 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9806
9807 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9808 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9809 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9810 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9811 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9812 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009813 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9814 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9815 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9816 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9817 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9818 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9819 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9820 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9821 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009822
9823 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9824
9825 Example :
9826 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9827 backend https
9828 mode tcp
9829 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009830 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009831 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009832
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009833 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9834 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9835
9836 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9837 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9838 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9839
9840 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9841 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009842
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009843 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9844 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9845 # at offset 44.
9846
9847 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9848 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9849
9850 # Learn on response if server hello.
9851 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009852
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009853 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9854 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9855
9856 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9857 extraction.
9858
9859
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009860tcp-check connect [params*]
9861 Opens a new connection
9862 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9863 no | no | yes | yes
9864
9865 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9866 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9867 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9868
9869 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9870 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9871 of the sequence.
9872
9873 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9874 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9875 do.
9876
9877 Parameters :
9878 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9879 use the TCP connection.
9880
9881 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9882 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9883 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9884
9885 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9886
9887 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9888
9889 Examples:
9890 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9891 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9892 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9893 option tcp-check
9894 tcp-check connect
9895 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9896 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9897 tcp-check send \r\n
9898 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9899 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9900 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9901 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9902 tcp-check send \r\n
9903 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9904 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9905
9906 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9907 option tcp-check
9908 tcp-check connect port 110
9909 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9910 tcp-check connect port 143
9911 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9912 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9913
9914 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9915
9916
9917tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009918 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009919 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9920 no | no | yes | yes
9921
9922 Arguments :
9923 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9924 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9925 binary.
9926 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9927 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9928 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9929
9930 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9931 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9932 with the usual backslash ('\').
9933 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009934 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009935 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9936 used upper or lower case.
9937
9938
9939 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9940
9941 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9942 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9943 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9944 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9945 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9946 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9947 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9948 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9949
9950 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9951 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9952 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9953 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9954 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9955 expression.
9956
9957 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9958 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9959 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9960 this exact hexadecimal string.
9961 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9962
9963 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9964 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9965 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9966 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9967 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9968 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9969 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9970 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9971 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9972 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9973 the null character.
9974
9975 Examples :
9976 # perform a POP check
9977 option tcp-check
9978 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9979
9980 # perform an IMAP check
9981 option tcp-check
9982 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9983
9984 # look for the redis master server
9985 option tcp-check
9986 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009987 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009988 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9989 tcp-check expect string role:master
9990 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9991 tcp-check expect string +OK
9992
9993
9994 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9995 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9996
9997
9998tcp-check send <data>
9999 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10000 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10001 no | no | yes | yes
10002
10003 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10004 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
10005
10006 Examples :
10007 # look for the redis master server
10008 option tcp-check
10009 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10010 tcp-check expect string role:master
10011
10012 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10013 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10014
10015
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010016tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
10017 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010018 tcp health check
10019 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10020 no | no | yes | yes
10021
10022 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10023 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010024 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010025 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10026 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
10027 hexadecimal string.
10028 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
10029
10030 Examples :
10031 # redis check in binary
10032 option tcp-check
10033 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10034 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10035
10036
10037 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10038 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10039
10040
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010041tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10042 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10044 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010045 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010046 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10047 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010049 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010050
10051 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10052 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010053 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10054 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10055 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10056 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10057 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10058 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010060 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10061 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10062 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10063 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010064
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010065 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010066 - accept :
10067 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10068 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10069 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010070
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010071 - reject :
10072 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10073 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10074 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10075 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10076 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10077 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10078 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10079 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10080 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10081 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10082 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010083 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010084
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010085 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10086 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10087 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10088 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10089 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10090 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10091 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10092 hosts.
10093
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010094 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10095 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10096 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10097 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10098 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10099 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10100 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10101 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10102
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010103 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10104 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10105 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10106 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10107 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10108 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10109 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10110 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10111 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010112 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10113 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010114
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010115 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010116 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010117 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10118 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10119 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010120 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010121 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10122 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10123 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10124 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10125 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10126 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10127 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10128 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010130 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010131 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010132 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010133 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010134 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10135 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10136 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010138 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10139 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10140 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10141 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010142
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010143 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10144 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10145 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10146 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10147 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010148 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10149 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10150 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10151 layer7 information is extracted.
10152
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010153 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10154 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10155 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10156 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10157 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010158
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010159 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10160 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10161 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10162 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10163
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010164 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10165 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10166 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10167 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10168
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010169 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10170 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10171 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10172 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10173 continues.
10174
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010175 - set-src <expr> :
10176 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10177 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10178 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010179 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010181 Arguments:
10182 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10183 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010184
10185 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010186 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10187
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010188 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10189 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010190
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010191 - set-src-port <expr> :
10192 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10193 expression.
10194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010195 Arguments:
10196 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10197 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010198
10199 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010200 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10201
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010202 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10203 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10204 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010205
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010206 - set-dst <expr> :
10207 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10208 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10209 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10210 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10211 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10212
10213 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10214 followed by some converters.
10215
10216 Example:
10217
10218 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10219 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10220
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010221 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10222 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10223
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010224 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10225 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10226 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10227 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10228
10229
10230 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10231 followed by some converters.
10232
10233 Example:
10234
10235 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10236
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010237 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10238 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10239 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10240
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010241 - "silent-drop" :
10242 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010243 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010244 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10245 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10246 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10247 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10248 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010249 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10250 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010251 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10252 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010253 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010254 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10255 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10256 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10257 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10258
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010259 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10260 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10261 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010263 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10264 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10265 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010266
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010267 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010268 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010269 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010270
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010271 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10272 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10273 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010275 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010276 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10277 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010278
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010279 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10280
10281 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10282
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010283 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10284
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010285 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010286
10287
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010288tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10289 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010291 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010292 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010293 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10294 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010295
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010296 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010297
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010298 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010299 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10300 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10301 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10302 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010304 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10305 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10306 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10307 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010308 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10309 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10310 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10311 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10312 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10313 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010314 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010315 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010316
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010317 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10318 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10319 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10320 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010321
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010322 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010323 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010324 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010325 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10326 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010327 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010328 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010329 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010330 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010331 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010332 - set-dst <expr>
10333 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet29873072021-06-23 12:07:21 +020010334 - set-src <expr>
10335 - set-src-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010336 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010337 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010338 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010339 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010340 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010341
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010342 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10343 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010344 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10345 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010346
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010347 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10348 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10349 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10350 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10351 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10352 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010353
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010354 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010355 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10356 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010357
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010358 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010359 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10360 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10361 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10362 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010363 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10364 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10365 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010366
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010367 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010368 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10369 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10370 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010371
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010372 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10373 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10374
Christopher Faulet29873072021-06-23 12:07:21 +020010375 The "set-src" and "set-src-port" are used to set respectively the source IP
10376 and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-src".
10377
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010378 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010379 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10380 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010381
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010382 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10383 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010384 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010385 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10386 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010387 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010388 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010389 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010390 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10391 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010392 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010393 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10394 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010395
10396 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10397 followed by some converters.
10398
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010399 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10400 <var-name>.
10401
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010402 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10403 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10404 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10405 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10406 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10407
10408 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10409 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10410 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10411 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10412 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10413 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10414 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10415 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10416 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10417 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10418 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10419
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010420 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10421 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10422 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10423 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10424 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10425
10426 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10427
10428 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10429
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010430 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10431 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10432 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10433 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10434 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10435 evaluated.
10436
10437 Example:
10438 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10439
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010440 Example:
10441
10442 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010443 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010444
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010445 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010446 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10447 # and reject everything else.
10448 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10449 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010450 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010451 tcp-request content reject
10452
10453 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010454 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10455 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10456 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010457 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010458
10459 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10460 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10461 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010462 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010463 tcp-request content reject
10464
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010465 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010466 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010467 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010468 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010469 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10470 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010471
10472 Example:
10473 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10474 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010475 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010476
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010477 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010478 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010479
10480 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010481 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010482 # protecting all our sites
10483 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010484 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10485 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010486 ...
10487 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10488
10489 backend http_dynamic
10490 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010491 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010492 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010493 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010494 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010495 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010496 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010498 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010499
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010500 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10501 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010502
10503
10504tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10505 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010507 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010508 Arguments :
10509 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10510 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10511 as explained at the top of this document.
10512
10513 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10514 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10515 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10516 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10517 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10518
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010519 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10520 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10521 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10522 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10523
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010524 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10525 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010526 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010527 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010528 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10529 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10530 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10531 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010532
10533 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10534 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10535 it pass through unaffected.
10536
10537 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10538 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10539 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010540 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010541 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10542 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010543 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10544 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10545 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010546
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010547 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010548 "timeout client".
10549
10550
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010551tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10552 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10554 no | no | yes | yes
10555 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010556 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10557 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010558
10559 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10560
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010561 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010562 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10563 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010564 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10565 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010566
10567 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10568
10569 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10570 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10571 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10572 inserted.
10573
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010574 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010575 - accept :
10576 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10577 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10578 the rules evaluation.
10579
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010580 - close :
10581 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10582 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10583 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10584 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10585 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10586 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010587 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010588 protocols.
10589
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010590 - reject :
10591 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10592 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010593 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010594
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010595 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10596 Sets a variable.
10597
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010598 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10599 Unsets a variable.
10600
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010601 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10602 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10603 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10604 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10605
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010606 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10607 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10608 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10609 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10610
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010611 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10612 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10613 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10614 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10615 continues.
10616
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010617 - "silent-drop" :
10618 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010619 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010620 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10621 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10622 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10623 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10624 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010625 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10626 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010627 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10628 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010629 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010630 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10631 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10632 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10633 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10634
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010635 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10636 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10637
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010638 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10639 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10640 for changing the default action to a reject.
10641
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010642 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10643 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10644 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10645 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010646 period.
10647
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010648 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10649 declared inline.
10650
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010651 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10652 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010653 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010654 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10655 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010656 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010657 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010658 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010659 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10660 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010661 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010662 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10663 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010664
10665 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10666 followed by some converters.
10667
10668 Example:
10669
10670 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10671
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010672 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10673 <var-name>.
10674
10675 Example:
10676
10677 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10678
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010679 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10680 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10681 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10682 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10683 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10684
10685 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10686
10687 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10688
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010689 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10690
10691 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10692
10693
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010694tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10695 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10697 no | yes | yes | no
10698 Arguments :
10699 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10700 below.
10701
10702 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10703
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010704 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010705 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10706 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10707 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10708 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10709 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10710 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10711 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010712 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010713 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10714 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10715 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10716 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10717 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10718 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10719 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10720 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10721 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10722 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10723 instead.
10724
10725 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10726 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10727 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10728 rules which may be inserted.
10729
10730 Several types of actions are supported :
10731 - accept : the request is accepted
10732 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10733 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10734 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010735 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010736 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Christopher Faulet5fe76a752021-06-23 12:19:25 +020010737 - set-dst <expr>
10738 - set-dst-port <expr>
10739 - set-src <expr>
10740 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010741 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010742 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010743 - silent-drop
10744
10745 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10746 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10747 sections for a complete description.
10748
10749 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10750 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10751 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10752
10753 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10754 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10755 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10756 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10757 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10758
10759 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10760 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10761
10762 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10763 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10764 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10765
10766 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10767 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10768 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10769
10770 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10771 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10772 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10773
10774 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10775 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10776 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10777
10778 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10779
10780 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10781
10782
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010783tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10784 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10786 no | no | yes | yes
10787 Arguments :
10788 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10789 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10790 as explained at the top of this document.
10791
10792 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10793
10794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010795timeout check <timeout>
10796 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10797 established.
10798
10799 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10800 yes | no | yes | yes
10801 Arguments:
10802 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10803 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10804 as explained at the top of this document.
10805
10806 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10807 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010808 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010809 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010810 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10811 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10812 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010813
10814 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10815 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10816
10817 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10818 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010819 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010820
10821 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10822 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10823 forget about it.
10824
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010825 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10826 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010827
10828
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010829timeout client <timeout>
10830timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10831 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10833 yes | yes | yes | no
10834 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010835 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010836 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10837 as explained at the top of this document.
10838
10839 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10840 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10841 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010842 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10843 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10844 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10845 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010846 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10847 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10848 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010849 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010850 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010851 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10852 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010853 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10854 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010855
10856 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10857 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10858 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10859 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010860 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010861 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10862
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010863 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010864
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010865 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10866 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10867 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10868
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010869 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10870 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010871
10872
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010873timeout client-fin <timeout>
10874 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10876 yes | yes | yes | no
10877 Arguments :
10878 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10879 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10880 as explained at the top of this document.
10881
10882 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10883 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10884 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10885 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10886 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10887 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10888 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010889 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10890 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10891 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010892
10893 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10894 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10895 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10896
10897 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10898
10899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010900timeout connect <timeout>
10901timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10902 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10904 yes | no | yes | yes
10905 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010906 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010907 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10908 as explained at the top of this document.
10909
10910 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010911 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010912 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010913 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010914 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10915 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010916
10917 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10918 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10919 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10920 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010921 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010922 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10923
10924 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10925 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10926 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10927
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010928 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10929 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010930
10931
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010932timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10933 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10935 yes | yes | yes | yes
10936 Arguments :
10937 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10938 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10939 as explained at the top of this document.
10940
10941 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10942 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10943 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10944 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10945 once the request has started to present itself.
10946
10947 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10948 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10949 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10950 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10951 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10952
10953 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10954 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10955 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10956 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10957
10958 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10959 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010960 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010961 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10962 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010963 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010964
10965 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10966 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10967 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10968 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10969
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010970 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10971 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010972 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10973
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010974 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10975
10976
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010977timeout http-request <timeout>
10978 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010980 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010981 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010982 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010983 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10984 as explained at the top of this document.
10985
10986 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10987 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10988 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10989 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10990 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10991 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10992 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010993 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10994 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10995 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10996 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010997 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010998 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10999 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011000
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011001 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11002 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11003 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11004 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11005 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011006 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011007
11008 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11009 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011010 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011011 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11012 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11013
11014 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011015 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11016 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11017 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011018
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011019 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011020 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011021
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011022
11023timeout queue <timeout>
11024 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11026 yes | no | yes | yes
11027 Arguments :
11028 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11030 as explained at the top of this document.
11031
11032 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11033 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11034 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11035 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11036 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11037
11038 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11039 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11040 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11041 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11042
11043 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11044
11045
11046timeout server <timeout>
11047timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
11048 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11050 yes | no | yes | yes
11051 Arguments :
11052 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11053 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11054 as explained at the top of this document.
11055
11056 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11057 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11058 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11059 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11060 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11061 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11062 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11063
11064 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11065 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11066 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11067 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11068 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011069 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011070 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011071 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11072 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011073 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11074 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011075
11076 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11077 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11078 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11079 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011080 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011081 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11082
11083 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
11084 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
11085 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
11086
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011087 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011088
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011089
11090timeout server-fin <timeout>
11091 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11093 yes | no | yes | yes
11094 Arguments :
11095 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11096 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11097 as explained at the top of this document.
11098
11099 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11100 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11101 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11102 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11103 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11104 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11105 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11106 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11107 situations, it should not be needed.
11108
11109 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11110 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11111 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11112
11113 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11114
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011115
11116timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011117 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11119 yes | yes | yes | yes
11120 Arguments :
11121 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11122 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11123 as explained at the top of this document.
11124
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011125 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11126 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11127 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11128 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011129
11130 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11131 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11132 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11133 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011134 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011135
11136 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11137
11138
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011139timeout tunnel <timeout>
11140 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11142 yes | no | yes | yes
11143 Arguments :
11144 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11145 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11146 as explained at the top of this document.
11147
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011148 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011149 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11150 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11151 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011152 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11153 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011154 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11155 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11156 specified.
11157
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011158 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11159 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11160 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11161 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11162 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11163 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11164 state.
11165
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011166 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11167 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11168 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11169 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011170 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011171
11172 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11173 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11174 forget about it.
11175
11176 Example :
11177 defaults http
11178 option http-server-close
11179 timeout connect 5s
11180 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011181 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011182 timeout server 30s
11183 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11184
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011185 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011186
11187
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011188transparent (deprecated)
11189 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011191 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011192 Arguments : none
11193
11194 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11195 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11196 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11197 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11198 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11199 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11200 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11201 appropriate server.
11202
11203 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11204
11205 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11206 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11207
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011208 See also: "option transparent"
11209
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011210unique-id-format <string>
11211 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11213 yes | yes | yes | no
11214 Arguments :
11215 <string> is a log-format string.
11216
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011217 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11218 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11219 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11220 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011221
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011222 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11223 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11224 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11225 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11226 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11227 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11228 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11229 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011230
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011231 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11232 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011233
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011234 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011235
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011236 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011237
11238 will generate:
11239
11240 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11241
11242 See also: "unique-id-header"
11243
11244unique-id-header <name>
11245 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11247 yes | yes | yes | no
11248 Arguments :
11249 <name> is the name of the header.
11250
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011251 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11252 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011253
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011254 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011255
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011256 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011257 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11258
11259 will generate:
11260
11261 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11262
11263 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011264
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011265use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011266 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11268 no | yes | yes | no
11269 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011270 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11271 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011272
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011273 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11274 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011275
11276 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11277 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11278 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011279 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011280 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011281 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11282 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011283
11284 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11285 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11286 assign the backend.
11287
11288 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11289 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11290 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11291 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11292 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11293 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11294
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011295 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011296 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011297 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11298 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11299 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11300
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011301 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11302 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11303 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11304 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11305 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11306 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11307 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11308 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11309 cannot be forced from the request.
11310
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011311 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011312 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11313 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11314
11315 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11316 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011317
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011318
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011319use-server <server> if <condition>
11320use-server <server> unless <condition>
11321 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11323 no | no | yes | yes
11324 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011325 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011326
11327 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11328
11329 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11330 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11331 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11332
11333 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11334 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11335 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11336 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11337 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11338 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11339 matches will assign the server.
11340
11341 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11342 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11343 with the next rules until one matches.
11344
11345 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11346 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11347 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11348 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11349
11350 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11351 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11352 stripped.
11353
11354 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11355 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11356 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11357 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11358
11359 Example :
11360 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11361 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11362 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11363 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11364 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11365 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011366 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011367 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11368 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11369
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011370 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011371
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011372
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100113735. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011374--------------------------
11375
11376The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11377depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11378settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11379written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11380described in this section.
11381
11382
113835.1. Bind options
11384-----------------
11385
11386The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11387as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11388no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11389parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11390while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11391provided immediately after the setting name.
11392
11393The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11394
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011395accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11396 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11397 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11398 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11399 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11400 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11401 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11402 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11403 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11404 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011405 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11406 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11407 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011408
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011409accept-proxy
11410 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011411 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11412 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011413 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11414 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11415 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11416 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011417 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011418 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11419 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011420 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11421 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011422
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011423allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011424 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011425 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011426 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011427 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11428 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011429
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011430alpn <protocols>
11431 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11432 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11433 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011434 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011435 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011436 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11437 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11438 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11439 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11440 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11441 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11442 preference, like below :
11443
11444 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011445
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011446backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011447 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011448 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11449
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011450curves <curves>
11451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11452 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11453 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11454 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11455 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11456 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11457
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011458ecdhe <named curve>
11459 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011460 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11461 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011462
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011463ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011464 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11465 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11466 client's certificate.
11467
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011468ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11469 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11470 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11471 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11472 error is ignored.
11473
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011474ca-sign-file <cafile>
11475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11476 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11477 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11478 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11479 'generate-certificates' for details.
11480
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011481ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011482 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11483 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11484 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11485 'generate-certificates' for details.
11486
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011487ciphers <ciphers>
11488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11489 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011490 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011491 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011492 information and recommendations see e.g.
11493 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11494 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11495 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11496
11497ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11498 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11499 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11500 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11501 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011502 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11503 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011504
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011505crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11507 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11508 to verify client's certificate.
11509
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011510crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011511 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11512 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11513 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11514 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11515 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11516 file.
11517
11518 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11519 are loaded.
11520
11521 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011522 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011523 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11524 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11525 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11526 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011527 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11528 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011529 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011530
11531 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11532 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11533 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11534 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011535 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11536 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011537
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011538 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011539
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011540 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011541 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011542 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11543 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011544 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11545 clients).
11546
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011547 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11548 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11549 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11550 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11551 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11552 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11553 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11554 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11555 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11556 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11557 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11558 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11559 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11560
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011561 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11562 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11563 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11564 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11565 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11566
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011567 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11568 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11569 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11570 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011571
11572 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11573 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11574 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11575 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11576 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11577 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11578 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11579 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11580 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11581
11582 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11583
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011584 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011585 a cert bundle.
11586
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011587 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011588 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11589 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11590 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11591 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11592 provide multi-cert support.
11593
11594 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11595
11596 Filename | CN | SAN
11597 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11598 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011599 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011600 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11601 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11602
11603 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11604 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11605 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11606 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011607 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11608 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11609 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011610
11611 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11612 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11613
11614 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11615 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11616 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11617
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011618crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011620 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011621 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011622 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011623
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011624crt-list <file>
11625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011626 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11627 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011628
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011629 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11630
William Lallemand0b77c182020-06-30 16:11:36 +020011631 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ciphers",
11632 "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names", "npn",
11633 "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
11634 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
11635 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011636
William Lallemandb0b703f2020-10-06 17:06:11 +020011637 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filters can be specified
11638 in the configuration, but they are only used as a hint, they don't do
11639 anything. (this changes in newer haproxy versions) If you want to exclude a
11640 SNI from a wildcard, use this positive SNI on another line. (like in the
11641 example).
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011642 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11643 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11644 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11645 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11646 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11647 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011648
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011649 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011650 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011651 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11652 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11653 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011654
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011655 crt-list file example:
11656 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011657 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011658 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011659 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011660
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011661defer-accept
11662 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11663 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11664 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011665 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011666 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11667 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11668 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11669 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11670 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11671 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11672 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11673
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011674expose-fd listeners
11675 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11676 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011677 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11678 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011679 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011680
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011681force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011682 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011683 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011684 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011685 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011686
11687force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011688 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011689 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011690 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011691
11692force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011693 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011694 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011695 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011696
11697force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011698 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011699 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011700 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011701
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011702force-tlsv13
11703 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11704 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011705 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011706
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011707generate-certificates
11708 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11709 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11710 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11711 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11712 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11713 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11714 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11715 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11716 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11717 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11718 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11719
11720 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11721 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011722 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011723 certificate is used many times.
11724
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011725gid <gid>
11726 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11727 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11728 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11729 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11730 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11731
11732group <group>
11733 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11734 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11735 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11736 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11737 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11738
11739id <id>
11740 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11741 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11742 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11743 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11744
11745interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011746 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11747 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11748 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11749 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11750 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11751 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011752 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11753 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11754 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11755 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11756 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11757 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011758
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011759level <level>
11760 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11761 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11762 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011763 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011764 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11765 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11766 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011767 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011768 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011769 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011770 all counters).
11771
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011772severity-output <format>
11773 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11774 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11775 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11776 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11777 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11778 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11779 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11780 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11781 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11782 rfc5424 convention.
11783
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011784maxconn <maxconn>
11785 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11786 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11787 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11788 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11789 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11790 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11791 eat all memory.
11792
11793mode <mode>
11794 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11795 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11796 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11797 UNIX sockets.
11798
11799mss <maxseg>
11800 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11801 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11802 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11803 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11804 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11805 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11806 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11807 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11808 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11809 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11810 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11811
11812name <name>
11813 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11814 page.
11815
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011816namespace <name>
11817 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11818 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11819 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11820 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11821
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011822nice <nice>
11823 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11824 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11825 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11826 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11827 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11828 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11829 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11830 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11831 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11832 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11833 one for an RDP socket.
11834
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011835no-ca-names
11836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11837 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11838
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011839no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011841 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011842 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011843 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011844 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11845 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011846
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011847no-tls-tickets
11848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11849 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11850 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011851 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11852 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011853 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11854 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11855 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011856
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011857no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011859 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011860 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011861 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011862 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11863 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011864
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011865no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011867 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011868 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011869 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011870 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11871 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011872
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011873no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011874 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011875 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011876 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011877 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011878 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11879 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011880
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011881no-tlsv13
11882 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11883 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11884 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11885 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011886 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11887 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011888
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011889npn <protocols>
11890 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11891 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11892 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011893 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011894 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011895 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11896 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11897 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11898 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11899 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011900
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011901prefer-client-ciphers
11902 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11903 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11904 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011905 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11906 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11907 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011908
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011909process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011910 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011911 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011912 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011913 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11914 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11915 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11916 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011917 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011918 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11919 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11920 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11921 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11922 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011923
11924 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11925
11926 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11927 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11928 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11929 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11930 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11931 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11932 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11933 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011934
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011935proto <name>
11936 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11937 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11938 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11939 in haproxy -vv.
11940 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11941 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011942 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011943 h2" on the bind line.
11944
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011945ssl
11946 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011947 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011948 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11949 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011950 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11951 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011952
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011953ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11954 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11955 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11956 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11957
11958ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11959 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11960 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11961 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11962
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011963strict-sni
11964 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11965 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11966 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11967 See the "crt" option for more information.
11968
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011969tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011970 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011971 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11972 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011973 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011974 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11975 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11976 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11977 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11978 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11979 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11980 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11981
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011982tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011983 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011984 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11985 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11986 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11987 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11988 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11989 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11990 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011991 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11992 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11993 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011994
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011995tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11996 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011997 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11998 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11999 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12000 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12001 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12002 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12003 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12004 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12005 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12006 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012007 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12008 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12009
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012010transparent
12011 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12012 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12013 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12014 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12015 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12016 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12017 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12018 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12019 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12020 so check for support with your vendor.
12021
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012022v4v6
12023 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12024 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12025 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12026 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012027 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012028
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012029v6only
12030 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12031 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12032 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012033 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12034 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012035
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012036uid <uid>
12037 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12038 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12039 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12040 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12041 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12042
12043user <user>
12044 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12045 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12046 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12047 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12048 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12049
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012050verify [none|optional|required]
12051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12052 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12053 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12054 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12055 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012056 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12057 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12058 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12059 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012060
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200120615.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012062------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012063
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012064The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12065which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12066arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12067settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12068after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12069Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12070address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012072 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012073 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012074
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012075Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12076keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012078The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012079
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012080addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012081 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012082 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12083 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12084 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12085 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12086 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012087
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012088agent-check
12089 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012090 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012091 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12092 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12093 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012094
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012095 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012096 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012097 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12098 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12099 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012100
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012101 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12102 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12103 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12104 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12105 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012106
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012107 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012108 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012109
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012110 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12111 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12112 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012113
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012114 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12115 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12116 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012117
William Dauchyd58def32020-09-26 13:35:51 +020012118 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012119 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12120 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12121 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12122 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012123 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012124 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012125
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012126 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12127 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012128
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012129 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12130 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12131 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12132 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12133 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12134 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12135 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12136 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12137 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012138
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012139 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12140 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012141 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12142 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12143 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012144 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012145
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012146 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012147 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012148
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012149agent-send <string>
12150 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12151 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12152 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12153 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12154 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12155
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012156agent-inter <delay>
12157 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12158 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12159
12160 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12161 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12162 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12163 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12164 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12165 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12166 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12167 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12168 of backends use the same servers.
12169
12170 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12171
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012172agent-addr <addr>
12173 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12174
12175 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12176 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12177 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12178 hostname, it will be resolved.
12179
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012180agent-port <port>
12181 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12182
12183 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12184
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012185allow-0rtt
12186 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012187 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12188 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012189
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012190alpn <protocols>
12191 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12192 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12193 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012194 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012195 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12196 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12197 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12198 now obsolete NPN extension.
12199 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12200 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12201
12202 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012204backup
12205 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12206 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12207 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12208 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012209 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12210 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012211
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012212ca-file <cafile>
12213 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12214 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12215 server's certificate.
12216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012217check
12218 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012219 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12220 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12221 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12222 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12223 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12224 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12225 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012226 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12227 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012228 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12229 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012230
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012231check-send-proxy
12232 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12233 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12234 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12235 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12236 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12237 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12238 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12239
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012240check-alpn <protocols>
12241 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12242 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12243 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12244
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012245check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012246 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012247 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12248 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012249
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012250check-ssl
12251 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12252 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12253 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12254 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012255 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012256 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12257 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012258 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012259 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12260 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012261
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012262check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012263 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012264 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12265 for normal traffic.
12266
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012267ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012268 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12269 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12270 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012271 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12272 information and recommendations see e.g.
12273 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12274 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12275 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012276
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012277ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12279 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12280 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12281 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012282 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12283 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12284 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012286cookie <value>
12287 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12288 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12289 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12290 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12291 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12292 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12293 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12294
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012295crl-file <crlfile>
12296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12297 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12298 to verify server's certificate.
12299
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012300crt <cert>
12301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12302 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12303 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12304 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12305 certificate request.
12306
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012307disabled
12308 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12309 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12310 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12311 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12312 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012313 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012314
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012315enabled
12316 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12317 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12318 default value.
12319 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12320 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012322error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012323 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12324 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12325 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012326
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012327 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012329fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012330 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12331 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12332 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12333
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012334force-sslv3
12335 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12336 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012337 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012338 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012339
12340force-tlsv10
12341 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012342 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012343 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012344
12345force-tlsv11
12346 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012347 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012348 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012349
12350force-tlsv12
12351 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012352 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012353 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012354
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012355force-tlsv13
12356 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12357 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012358 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012360id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012361 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12362 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12363 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012364
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012365init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12366 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12367 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012368 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012369 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12370 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12371 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12372 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12373 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12374 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12375 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12376 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12377 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012378 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012379 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12380 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12381 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12382 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12383 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12384 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012385 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012386
12387 Example:
12388 defaults
12389 # never fail on address resolution
12390 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12391
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012392inter <delay>
12393fastinter <delay>
12394downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012395 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12396 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12397 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12398 between checks depending on the server state :
12399
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012400 Server state | Interval used
12401 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12402 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12403 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12404 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12405 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12406 or yet unchecked. |
12407 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12408 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12409 | "inter" otherwise.
12410 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012412 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12413 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12414 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12415 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012416 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12417 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12418 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12419 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12420 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012422maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012423 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12424 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012425 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12426 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012427 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12428 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12429 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12430 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12431
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012432 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12433 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12434 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12435 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12436 than 50 concurrent requests.
12437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012438maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012439 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12440 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12441 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12442 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12443 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12444 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12445 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12446
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012447max-reuse <count>
12448 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12449 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12450 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12451 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12452 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12453 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12454 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12455 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12456
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012457minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012458 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12459 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12460 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12461 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12462 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12463 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012464 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012465 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012466
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012467namespace <name>
12468 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12469 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12470 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12471 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12472
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012473no-agent-check
12474 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12475 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12476 default value.
12477 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12478 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12479
12480no-backup
12481 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12482 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12483 default value.
12484 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12485 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12486
12487no-check
12488 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12489 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12490 default value.
12491 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12492 "default-server" "check" setting.
12493
12494no-check-ssl
12495 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12496 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12497 default value.
12498 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12499 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12500
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012501no-send-proxy
12502 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12503 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12504 default value.
12505 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12506 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12507
12508no-send-proxy-v2
12509 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12510 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12511 default value.
12512 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12513 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12514
12515no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12516 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12517 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12518 default value.
12519 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12520 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12521
12522no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12523 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12524 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12525 default value.
12526 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12527 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12528
12529no-ssl
12530 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12531 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12532 default value.
12533 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12534 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12535
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012536no-ssl-reuse
12537 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12538 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12539 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12540 and for paranoid users.
12541
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012542no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012543 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12544 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012545 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012546
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012547 Supported in default-server: No
12548
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012549no-tls-tickets
12550 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12551 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12552 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012553 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12554 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012555 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12556 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12557 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012558 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012559
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012560no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012561 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012562 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12563 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012564 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12565 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012566 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012567
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012568 Supported in default-server: No
12569
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012570no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012571 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012572 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12573 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012574 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12575 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012576 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012577
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012578 Supported in default-server: No
12579
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012580no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012581 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012582 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12583 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012584 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12585 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012586 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012587
12588 Supported in default-server: No
12589
12590no-tlsv13
12591 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12592 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12593 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12594 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12595 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012596 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012597
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012598 Supported in default-server: No
12599
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012600no-verifyhost
12601 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12602 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12603 default value.
12604 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12605 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012606
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012607no-tfo
12608 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12609 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12610 default value.
12611 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12612 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12613
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012614non-stick
12615 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12616 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12617 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12618
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012619npn <protocols>
12620 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12621 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12622 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012623 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012624 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12625 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12626 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012628observe <mode>
12629 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12630 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12631 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12632 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12633 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12634 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012635 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012636
12637 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012639on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012640 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12641 Currently, four modes are available:
12642 - fastinter: force fastinter
12643 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12644 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12645 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12646 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12647
12648 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12649
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012650on-marked-down <action>
12651 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12652 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012653 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12654 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12655 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12656 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12657 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12658 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12659 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12660 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012661
12662 Actions are disabled by default
12663
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012664on-marked-up <action>
12665 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12666 Currently one action is available:
12667 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12668 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12669 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12670 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012671 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12672 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012673 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12674 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12675
12676 Actions are disabled by default
12677
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012678pool-max-conn <max>
12679 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12680 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12681 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12682 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12683 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12684 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12685
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012686pool-purge-delay <delay>
12687 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012688 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012689 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012691port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012692 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12693 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12694 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12695 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12696 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12697 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12698
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012699proto <name>
12700
12701 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12702 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12703 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12704 reported in haproxy -vv.
12705 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12706 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12707
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012708redir <prefix>
12709 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12710 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12711 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12712 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12713 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12714 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12715 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12716 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012717 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012718 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012719 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12720 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12721 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12722 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12723
12724 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012726rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012727 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12728 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12729 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12730
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012731resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12732 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12733 server.
12734
12735 Available options:
12736
12737 * allow-dup-ip
12738 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12739 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12740 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12741 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12742 For such case, simply enable this option.
12743 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12744
12745 * prevent-dup-ip
12746 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12747 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12748 same fqdn.
12749 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12750
12751 Example:
12752 backend b_myapp
12753 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12754 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12755 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12756
12757 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12758 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12759 it
12760 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12761 different address
12762
12763 Default value: not set
12764
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012765resolve-prefer <family>
12766 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12767 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12768 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12769 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12770
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012771 Default value: ipv6
12772
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012773 Example:
12774
12775 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012776
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012777resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012778 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012779 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012780 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012781 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12782 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012783 configured network, another address is selected.
12784
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012785 Example:
12786
12787 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012788
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012789resolvers <id>
12790 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12791 hostname.
12792
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012793 Example:
12794
12795 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012796
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012797 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012798
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012799send-proxy
12800 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12801 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12802 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12803 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012804 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12805 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12806 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12807 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12808 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12809 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12810 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12811 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12812 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12813 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012814 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12815 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012816
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012817send-proxy-v2
12818 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12819 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12820 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12821 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012822 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12823 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12824 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12825 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012826
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012827proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12828 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12829 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012830 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12831 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012832 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12833 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012834 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012835
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012836send-proxy-v2-ssl
12837 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12838 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12839 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12840 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12841 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12842 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12843 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012844 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12845 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012846
12847send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12848 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12849 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12850 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12851 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12852 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12853 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12854 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12855 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012856 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12857 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012859slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012860 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12861 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12862 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12863 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12864 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12865 parameters :
12866
12867 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12868 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12869
12870 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12871 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12872 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12873 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12874
12875 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12876 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12877 seen as failed.
12878
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012879sni <expression>
12880 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12881 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12882 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12883 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012884 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12885 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012886 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012887 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12888 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012889
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012890source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012891source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012892source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012893 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12894 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12895 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12896 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12897
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012898 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12899 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12900 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12901 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12902 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12903 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12904 server.
12905
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012906 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12907 specifying the source address without port(s).
12908
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012909ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012910 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12911 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12912 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12913 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12914 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12915 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012916 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12917 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012918
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012919ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12920 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12921 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12922 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12923
12924ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12925 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12926 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12927 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12928
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012929ssl-reuse
12930 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12931 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12932 default value.
12933 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12934 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12935
12936stick
12937 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12938 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12939 default value.
12940 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12941 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012942
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012943socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012944 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012945 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12946 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12947
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012948tcp-ut <delay>
12949 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12950 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12951 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012952 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012953 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12954 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12955 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12956 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12957 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12958 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12959 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12960 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12961 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12962
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012963tfo
12964 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12965 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12966 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12967 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12968 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012969 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012970
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012971track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012972 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12973 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12974 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12975 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012976 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12977
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012978tls-tickets
12979 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12980 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12981 default value.
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012982 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12983 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12984 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012985 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke04037d32020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012986 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012987
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012988verify [none|required]
12989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012990 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012991 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12992 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012993 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012994 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12995 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12996 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12997 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12998 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12999 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13000 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13001 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013002
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013003verifyhost <hostname>
13004 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013005 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13006 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13007 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13008 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13009 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13010 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13011 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13012 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013014weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013015 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13016 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13017 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013018 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13019 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13020 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13021 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13022 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13023 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013024
13025
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130265.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13027-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013028
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013029HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13030using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070013031configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013032This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13033can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13034workload.
13035This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13036resolution at run time.
13037Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13038carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13039
13040
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130415.3.1. Global overview
13042----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013043
13044As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13045different steps of the process life:
13046
13047 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13048 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13049 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13050
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013051 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13052 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013053
13054A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13055 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13056 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13057 resolution to know this new IP.
13058
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013059When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013060HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013061SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13062from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13063will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13064will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013065
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013066A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013067 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013068 first valid response.
13069
13070 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13071 servers return an error.
13072
13073
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130745.3.2. The resolvers section
13075----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013076
13077This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013078HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13079contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013080
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013081When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13082uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13083is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13084answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13085
13086When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013087used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013088
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013089 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13090 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13091 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013092
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013093 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13094 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013095
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013096 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13097 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13098 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013099
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013100For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13101following scenarios are possible:
13102
13103 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13104 ignored
13105
13106 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13107 applied
13108
13109 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13110 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13111
13112 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13113 retries the query with a new type
13114
13115 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13116 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013117
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013118As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13119a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013120<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013121
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013122
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013123resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013124 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013125
13126A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13127
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013128accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013129 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013130 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013131 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13132 by RFC 6891)
13133
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013134 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13135
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013136nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13137 DNS server description:
13138 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13139 <ip> : IP address of the server
13140 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13141
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013142parse-resolv-conf
13143 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13144 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13145 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13146
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013147hold <status> <period>
13148 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13149 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013150 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013151 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013152 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13153 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13154 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13155
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013156 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013157
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013158resolve_retries <nb>
13159 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13160 giving up.
13161 Default value: 3
13162
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013163 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13164 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13165 type.
13166
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013167timeout <event> <time>
13168 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13169 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13170 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013171 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13172 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013173 Default value: 1s
13174 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013175 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013176 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013177 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13178 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13179
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013180 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013181
13182 resolvers mydns
13183 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13184 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013185 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013186 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013187 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013188 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013189 hold other 30s
13190 hold refused 30s
13191 hold nx 30s
13192 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013193 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013194 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013195
13196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131976. HTTP header manipulation
13198---------------------------
13199
13200In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13201response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13202request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13203which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013204against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013205
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013206If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13207to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13208but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13209HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13210stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13211because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13212a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13213still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013215This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13216in section 4.2 :
13217
13218 - reqadd <string>
13219 - reqallow <search>
13220 - reqiallow <search>
13221 - reqdel <search>
13222 - reqidel <search>
13223 - reqdeny <search>
13224 - reqideny <search>
13225 - reqpass <search>
13226 - reqipass <search>
13227 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13228 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13229 - reqtarpit <search>
13230 - reqitarpit <search>
13231 - rspadd <string>
13232 - rspdel <search>
13233 - rspidel <search>
13234 - rspdeny <search>
13235 - rspideny <search>
13236 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13237 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13238
13239With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13240is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13241parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13242prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13243Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13244
13245 \t for a tab
13246 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13247 \n for a new line (LF)
13248 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13249 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13250 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13251 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13252 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13253
13254The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13255portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13256above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13257regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
132589 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13259is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13260
13261The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13262after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13263
13264Notes related to these keywords :
13265---------------------------------
13266 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13267 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13268 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13269
13270 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13271 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13272 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13273
13274 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13275 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13276 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13277 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13278 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13279
13280 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13281 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13282 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13283 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13284 useless headers before adding new ones.
13285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013286 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013287 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13288
13289 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13290 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13291 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13292
13293 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13294 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013295 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013296
13297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132987. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13299----------------------------------
13300
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013301HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013302client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13303The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13304these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13305but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13306data called patterns.
13307
13308
133097.1. ACL basics
13310---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013311
13312The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13313content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13314from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13315simple :
13316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013317 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013318 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013319 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13320 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013322The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13323adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013324
13325In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013327 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013328
13329This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13330Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13331and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013332an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13333conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13334as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13335are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013336
13337ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13338'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13339which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13340
13341There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13342performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013344The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13345specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13346this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013347methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13348ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013349
13350Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13351 - boolean
13352 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13353 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13354 - string
13355 - data block
13356
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013357Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13358converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13359would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13360The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13361which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13362
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013363Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13364keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13365fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13366which are summarized in the table below :
13367
13368 +---------------------+-----------------+
13369 | Sample or converter | Default |
13370 | output type | matching method |
13371 +---------------------+-----------------+
13372 | boolean | bool |
13373 +---------------------+-----------------+
13374 | integer | int |
13375 +---------------------+-----------------+
13376 | ip | ip |
13377 +---------------------+-----------------+
13378 | string | str |
13379 +---------------------+-----------------+
13380 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13381 +---------------------+-----------------+
13382
13383Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13384matching method, see below.
13385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013386The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13387 - boolean
13388 - integer or integer range
13389 - IP address / network
13390 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13391 - regular expression
13392 - hex block
13393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013394The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13395
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013396 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13397 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013398 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013399 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013400 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013401 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013402 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013404The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13405read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13406if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13407lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13408will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13409beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13410a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13411lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13412exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13413
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013414The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13415parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13416ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13417a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13418check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13419
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013420The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13421socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13422file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013424Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13425loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13426
13427 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13428
13429In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13430the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13431case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13432as well.
13433
13434The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13435sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13436do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13437methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13438is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013439obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013440followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13441default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13442that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13443string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13444
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013445The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13446By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13447string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13448resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13449server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013450waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013451flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13452function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013454There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13455sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13456be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013457
13458 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13459 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013460 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13461 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13462 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13463 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013464
13465 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13466 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013468
13469 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013470 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013471
13472 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013474
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013475 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013476 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13477
13478 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13479 binary or string samples.
13480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013481 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13482 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013484 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13485 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13486 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013488 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13489 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013491 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13492 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013494 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13495 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013497 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13498 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013499 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013501 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13502 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13503 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013504
13505For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13506request, it is possible to do :
13507
13508 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13509
13510In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13511buffer, one would use the following acl :
13512
13513 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13514
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013515On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13516possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13517
13518 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013520All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13521criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13522method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13523to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13524criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13525the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013527If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013528the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13529For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013531 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13532 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13533 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13534 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013535
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013536
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013537The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13538types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13539combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13540brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13541default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013543 +-------------------------------------------------+
13544 | Input sample type |
13545 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013546 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013547 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13548 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13549 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013550 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013551 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013552 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013553 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013554 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013555 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013556 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013557 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013558 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013559 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013560 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013561 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013562 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013563 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013564 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013565 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013566 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013567 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013568 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013569 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013570 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013571 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13572 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13573 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013574
13575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135767.1.1. Matching booleans
13577------------------------
13578
13579In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13580Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13581When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13582that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13583
13584Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13585return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13586"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13587
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135897.1.2. Matching integers
13590------------------------
13591
13592Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13593enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13594to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13595
13596Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13597matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13598lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013599
13600For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13601unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13602representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13603
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013604As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13605two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13606instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13607ranges and operators.
13608
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013609For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013610operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13611Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13612of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013613
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013614Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013615
13616 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13617 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13618 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13619 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13620 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13621
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013622For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013623
13624 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13625
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013626This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13627
13628 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13629
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136317.1.3. Matching strings
13632-----------------------
13633
13634String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13635different forms :
13636
13637 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013638 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013639
13640 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013641 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013642
13643 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13644 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13645
13646 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13647 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13648
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013649 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013650 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13651 matches.
13652
13653 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13654 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13655 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013656
13657String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13658exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13659characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13660string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13661to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013662before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013663
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013664Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13665(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13666Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13667
13668Example:
13669 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13670 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13674---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013675
13676Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13677they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13678possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13679passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13680the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013681the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13682match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013683
13684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136857.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13686-------------------------------------
13687
13688It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13689not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13690a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13691to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13692digits may be used upper or lower case.
13693
13694Example :
13695 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13696 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13697
13698
136997.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13700---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013701
13702IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13703netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13704within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013705host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013706difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13707at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13708does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13709parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013710
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013711The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13712abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13713
13714 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13715 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13716 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13717 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13718 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13719 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13720 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13721 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13722
13723Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13724192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13725
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013726IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13727Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13728trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13729IPv6 patterns.
13730
13731HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13732following situations :
13733 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13734 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13735 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13736 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13737 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13738 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13739 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13740 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13741 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13742 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013744
137457.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13746----------------------------------
13747
13748Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13749combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13750
13751 - AND (implicit)
13752 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13753 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013755A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013757 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013759Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13760indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013762For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13763"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13764requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13765is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13766
13767 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013768 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13769 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13770 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013771
13772To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13773and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13774
13775 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13776 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13777 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13778 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13779
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013780 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013781 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13782 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13783 use_backend www if host_www
13784
13785It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13786expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13787be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13788the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13789
13790 The following rule :
13791
13792 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013793 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013794
13795 Can also be written that way :
13796
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013797 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013798
13799It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13800to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13801simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13802sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13803good use is the following :
13804
13805 With named ACLs :
13806
13807 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13808 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13809 monitor fail if site_dead
13810
13811 With anonymous ACLs :
13812
13813 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13814
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013815See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13816keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013817
13818
138197.3. Fetching samples
13820---------------------
13821
13822Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13823against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13824sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13825ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13826of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13827available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13828
13829This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13830Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13831compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13832deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13833
13834The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13835matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13836method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13837indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13838
13839As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13840when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13841mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13842the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13843ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13844
13845Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13846multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13847when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013848incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13849are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013850is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13851all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13852
13853Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13854 - name
13855 - name(arg1)
13856 - name(arg1,arg2)
13857
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013858
138597.3.1. Converters
13860-----------------
13861
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013862Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13863of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13864is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13865was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013866has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013867unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13868
13869These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13870sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13871the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013872support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013873
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013874A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13875support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13876supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13877(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13878bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013880The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013881
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001388251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13883 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13884 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13885 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13886 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13887 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13888
13889 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013890 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13891 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013892 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13893 frontend http-in
13894 bind *:8081
13895 default_backend servers
13896 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13897 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13898
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013899add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013900 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013901 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013902 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13903 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013904 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013905 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13906 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13907 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13908 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013909 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013910 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013911
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013912aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13913 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13914 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13915 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13916 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13917 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13918 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13919
13920 Example:
13921 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13922 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13923
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013924and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013925 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013926 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013927 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13928 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013929 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013930 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13931 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13932 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13933 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013934 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013935 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013936
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013937b64dec
13938 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13939 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13940
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013941base64
13942 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013943 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013944 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13945
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013946bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013947 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013948 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013949 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013950 presence of a flag).
13951
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013952bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13953 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13954 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013955 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013956
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013957concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13958 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13959 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13960 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13961 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13962 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13963 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13964 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13965 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13966 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13967 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013968 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013969 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013970 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013971
13972 Example:
13973 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13974 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13975 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13976 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13977
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013978cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013979 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13980 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013981
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013982crc32([<avalanche>])
13983 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13984 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13985 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13986 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13987 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13988 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13989 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13990 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13991 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13992 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013993 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13994
13995crc32c([<avalanche>])
13996 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13997 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13998 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13999 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14000 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14001 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14002 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14003 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014004
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014005da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014006 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14007 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14008 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14009 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014010 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014011 configuration language.
14012
14013 Example:
14014 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014015 bind *:8881
14016 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014017 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014018
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014019debug
14020 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
14021 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
14022 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
14023
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014024div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014025 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14026 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014027 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014028 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14029 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014030 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014031 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14032 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14033 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14034 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014035 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014036 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014037
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014038djb2([<avalanche>])
14039 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14040 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14041 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14042 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14043 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14044 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14045 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014046 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14047 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014048
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014049even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014050 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014051 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14052
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014053field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14054 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14055 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14056 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14057 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14058 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14059 fields.
14060
14061 Example :
14062 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14063 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14064 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14065 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14066 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014067
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014068hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014069 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014070 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014071 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014072 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014073
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014074hex2i
14075 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014076 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014077
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014078http_date([<offset>])
14079 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14080 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
14081 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
14082 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
14083 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
14084 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014085
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014086in_table(<table>)
14087 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14088 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14089 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014090 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014091 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14092
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014093ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14094 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014095 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014096 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14097 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14098 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14099 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14100 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014101
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014102json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014103 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014104 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014105 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014106 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14107 of errors:
14108 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14109 bytes, ...)
14110 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14111 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14112
14113 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14114 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14115 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14116 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14117 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14118 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014119 - "ascii" : never fails;
14120 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14121 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014122 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014123 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014124 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14125 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14126
14127 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014128 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014129
14130 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014131 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014132 capture request header user-agent len 150
14133 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014134
14135 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14136 GET / HTTP/1.0
14137 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14138
14139 Output log:
14140 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14141
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014142language(<value>[,<default>])
14143 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14144 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14145 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14146 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14147 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14148 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14149 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14150 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14151 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014152 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014153 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14154 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014155
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014156 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014157
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014158 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14159 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014160
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014161 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14162 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14163 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14164 use_backend spanish if es
14165 use_backend french if fr
14166 use_backend english if en
14167 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014168
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014169length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014170 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14171 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14172 type. The result is of type integer.
14173
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014174lower
14175 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14176 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14177 type. The result is of type string.
14178
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014179ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14180 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14181 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14182 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14183 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14184 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14185 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14186
14187 Example :
14188
14189 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014190 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014191 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14192
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014193map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14194map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14195map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14196 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14197 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14198 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14199 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14200 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14201 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14202 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14203 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014204
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014205 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14206 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14207 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014208
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014209 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014210 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014211
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014212 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14213 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14214 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14215 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014216 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14217 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014218 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14219 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14220 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14221 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14222 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14223 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14224 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14225 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014226 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14227 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14228 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014229 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14230 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14231 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14232 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14233 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014234
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014235 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14236 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14237 the corresponding match text.
14238
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014239 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14240 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14241 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14242 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14243 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014244
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014245 Example :
14246
14247 # this is a comment and is ignored
14248 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14249 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14250 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14251 | | | `---------- value
14252 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14253 | `---------------------------- key
14254 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14255
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014256mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014257 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14258 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014259 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014260 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014261 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014262 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14263 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14264 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14265 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014266 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014267 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014268
14269mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014270 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014271 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14272 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014273 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014274 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014275 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014276 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14277 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14278 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14279 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014280 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014281 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014282
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014283nbsrv
14284 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14285 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14286 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14287 map lookup.
14288
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014289neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014290 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14291 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14292 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14293 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014294
14295not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014296 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014297 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014298 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014299 absence of a flag).
14300
14301odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014302 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014303 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14304
14305or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014306 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014307 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014308 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14309 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014310 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014311 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14312 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14313 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14314 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014315 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014316 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014317
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014318protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14319 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14320 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14321 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14322 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14323 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14324 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14325 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14326 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14327 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14328 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14329 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14330
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014331regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014332 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14333 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14334 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14335 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14336 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14337 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14338 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14339 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14340 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14341 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014342 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14343 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14344 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14345 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014346
14347 Example :
14348
14349 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14350 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14351 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14352 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14353
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014354capture-req(<id>)
14355 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14356 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14357
14358 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014359 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14360 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014361
14362capture-res(<id>)
14363 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14364 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14365
14366 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014367 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14368 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014369
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014370sdbm([<avalanche>])
14371 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14372 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14373 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14374 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14375 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14376 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14377 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014378 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14379 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014380
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014381set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014382 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14383 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14384 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014385 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014386 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14387 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014388 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014389 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14390 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014391 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014392 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014393
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014394sha1
14395 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14396 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14397
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014398strcmp(<var>)
14399 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14400 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14401 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14402 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14403 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14404 shorter).
14405
14406 Example :
14407
14408 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14409 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14410 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14411
14412
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014413sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014414 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14415 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014416 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014417 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14418 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014419 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014420 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14421 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014422 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014423 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14424 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014425 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014426 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014427
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014428table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14429 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14430 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14431 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14432 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14433 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14434 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14435
14436
14437table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14438 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14439 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14440 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14441 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14442 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14443 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14444
14445table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14446 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14447 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014448 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014449 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14450 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14451
14452table_conn_cur(<table>)
14453 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14454 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14455 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14456 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14457 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14458
14459table_conn_rate(<table>)
14460 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14461 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14462 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14463 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14464 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14465
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014466table_gpt0(<table>)
14467 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14468 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14469 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14470 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14471 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14472
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014473table_gpc0(<table>)
14474 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14475 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14476 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14477 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14478 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14479
14480table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14481 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14482 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14483 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14484 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14485 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14486 sample fetch keyword.
14487
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014488table_gpc1(<table>)
14489 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14490 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14491 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14492 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14493 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14494
14495table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14496 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14497 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14498 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14499 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14500 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14501 sample fetch keyword.
14502
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014503table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14504 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14505 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014506 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014507 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14508 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14509
14510table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14511 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14512 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14513 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14514 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14515 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14516 keyword.
14517
14518table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14519 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14520 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014521 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014522 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14523 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14524
14525table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14526 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14527 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14528 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14529 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14530 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14531 keyword.
14532
14533table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14534 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14535 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014536 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014537 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14538 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14539 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14540 keyword.
14541
14542table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14543 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14544 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014545 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014546 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14547 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14548 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14549 keyword.
14550
14551table_server_id(<table>)
14552 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14553 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14554 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14555 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14556 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14557 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14558
14559table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14560 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14561 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014562 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014563 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14564 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14565 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14566 keyword.
14567
14568table_sess_rate(<table>)
14569 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14570 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14571 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14572 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14573 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14574 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14575 keyword.
14576
14577table_trackers(<table>)
14578 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14579 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14580 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14581 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14582 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14583 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14584 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14585 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14586 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14587 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14588
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014589upper
14590 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14591 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14592 type. The result is of type string.
14593
Willy Tarreau7e913cb2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014594url_dec([<in_form>])
14595 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14596 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14597 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14598 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14599 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14600 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014601
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014602ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014603 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014604 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14605 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14606 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014607 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14608 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14609 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14610 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014611 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014612 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14613 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014614
14615 Example:
14616 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14617 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14618
14619 message Point {
14620 int32 latitude = 1;
14621 int32 longitude = 2;
14622 }
14623
14624 message PPoint {
14625 Point point = 59;
14626 }
14627
14628 message Rectangle {
14629 // One corner of the rectangle.
14630 PPoint lo = 48;
14631 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14632 PPoint hi = 49;
14633 }
14634
14635 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14636 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14637 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14638
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014639 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14640 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014641 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014642 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14643
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014644 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014645
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014646 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014647
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014648 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014649 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14650 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14651
14652 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14653 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14654 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14655
14656 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14657 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14658 interpret the previous binary sample.
14659
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014660
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014661unset-var(<var name>)
14662 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14663 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14664 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14665 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14666 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14667 response),
14668 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14669 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14670 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14671 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14672
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014673utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14674 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14675 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14676 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14677 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14678 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14679 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14680
14681 Example :
14682
14683 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014684 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014685 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14686
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014687word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14688 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14689 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14690 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014691 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014692 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14693 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14694
14695 Example :
14696 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14697 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14698 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14699 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14700 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014701 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014702
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014703wt6([<avalanche>])
14704 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14705 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14706 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14707 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14708 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14709 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14710 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014711 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14712 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014713
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014714xor(<value>)
14715 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014716 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014717 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014718 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014719 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014720 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14721 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014722 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014723 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14724 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014725 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014726 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014727
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014728xxh32([<seed>])
14729 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14730 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14731 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14732 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14733 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14734 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14735 as cryptographically secure.
14736
14737xxh64([<seed>])
14738 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14739 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14740 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14741 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14742 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14743 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14744 as cryptographically secure.
14745
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014746
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147477.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014748--------------------------------------------
14749
14750A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14751not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14752"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14753The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14754
14755always_false : boolean
14756 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14757 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14758
14759always_true : boolean
14760 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14761 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14762
14763avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014764 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014765 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14766 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14767 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14768 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14769 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14770 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14771 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14772 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14773 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14774 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14775 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14776 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14777 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014779be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014780 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14781 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14782 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14783 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014784 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14785
14786be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14787 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14788 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14789 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14790 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14791 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014792 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14793 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014794
14795 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14796 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14797 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014799be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14800 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14801 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14802 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014803 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14805 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014806
14807 Example :
14808 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14809 backend dynamic
14810 mode http
14811 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14812 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014813
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014814bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014815 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14816 of the string.
14817
14818bool(<bool>) : bool
14819 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14820 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014822connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14823 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014824 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14826 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014827
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014828 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014829 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014830 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14831
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014832 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14833 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014834
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014835 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014836 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014837 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014838 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014839 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014840 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014841 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014842
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014843 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14844 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014845 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014846 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014847
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014848cpu_calls : integer
14849 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14850 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14851 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14852 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14853 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14854 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14855
14856cpu_ns_avg : integer
14857 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14858 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14859 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14860 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14861 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14862 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14863 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14864 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14865 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14866 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14867 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14868
14869cpu_ns_tot : integer
14870 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14871 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14872 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14873 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14874 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14875 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14876 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14877 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14878 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14879 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14880 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14881 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14882 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14883
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014884date([<offset>]) : integer
14885 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14886 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14887 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14888 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014889 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14890
14891 Example :
14892
14893 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14894 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014895
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014896date_us : integer
14897 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14898 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14899 from the same timeval structure.
14900
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014901distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14902 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14903 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14904 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14905 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14906 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14907 list of supported tokens.
14908
14909distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14910 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14911 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14912 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14913 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14914 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14915 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14916 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14917 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14918 supported tokens.
14919
14920 Example :
14921 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14922 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14923 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14924 # send large files to the big farm
14925 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14926
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014927env(<name>) : string
14928 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14929 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14930 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14931 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14932 certain way.
14933
14934 Examples :
14935 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14936 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14937
14938 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14939 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014941fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14942 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014943 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14944 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014945 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14946 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014947 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014948 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14949 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014950
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014951fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14952 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14953 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14954 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014956fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14957 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14958 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14959 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14960 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14961 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14962 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14963 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14964 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014965
14966 Example :
14967 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14968 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14969 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14970 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14971 frontend mail
14972 bind :25
14973 mode tcp
14974 maxconn 100
14975 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14976 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14977 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14978 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014979
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014980hostname : string
14981 Returns the system hostname.
14982
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014983int(<integer>) : signed integer
14984 Returns a signed integer.
14985
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014986ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14987 Returns an ipv4.
14988
14989ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14990 Returns an ipv6.
14991
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014992lat_ns_avg : integer
14993 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14994 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14995 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14996 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14997 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14998 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14999 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15000 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15001 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15002 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15003 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15004 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15005 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15006 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15007
15008lat_ns_tot : integer
15009 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15010 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15011 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15012 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15013 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15014 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15015 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15016 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15017 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15018 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15019 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15020 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15021 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15022 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15023 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15024 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15025 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15026 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15027 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15028
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015029meth(<method>) : method
15030 Returns a method.
15031
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015032nbproc : integer
15033 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15034 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15035 and debugging purposes.
15036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015037nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15038 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15039 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15040 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015041 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15042 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15043 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015044
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015045prio_class : integer
15046 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15047 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15048 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15049
15050prio_offset : integer
15051 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15052 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15053 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15054 set-priority-offset".
15055
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015056proc : integer
15057 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15058 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15059 debugging purposes.
15060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015061queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015062 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15063 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15064 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015065 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15066 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15067 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15068 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15069 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15070
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015071rand([<range>]) : integer
15072 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15073 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15074 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15075 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15076 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15077
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015078uuid([<version>]) : string
15079 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15080 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15081 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015083srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15084 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15085 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15086 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15087 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15088 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015089 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15090 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15091
15092srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15093 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15094 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15095 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15096 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15097 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15098 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15099 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15100
15101 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15102 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015103
15104srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15105 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15106 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15107 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015108 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015109 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15110 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15111 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15112
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015113srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15114 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15115 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15116 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15117 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15118 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15119 fetch methods.
15120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015121srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15122 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15123 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015124 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015125 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15126 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015127 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128 overloading servers).
15129
15130 Example :
15131 # Redirect to a separate back
15132 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15133 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15134 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15135
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015136stopping : boolean
15137 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15138 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15139 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15140
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015141str(<string>) : string
15142 Returns a string.
15143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015144table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15145 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15146 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15147
15148table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15149 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15150 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15151 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15152
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015153thread : integer
15154 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15155 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15156 and debugging purposes.
15157
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015158var(<var-name>) : undefined
15159 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015160 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15161 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015162 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015163 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15164 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015165 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015166 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15167 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015168 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015169 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015170
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151717.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015172----------------------------------
15173
15174The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15175closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15176methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15177sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15178TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015179the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15180counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015181"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15182used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15183can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15184Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15185table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15186tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15187currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015188
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015189bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015190 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15191 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15192 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015194be_id : integer
15195 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15196 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15197
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015198be_name : string
15199 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15200 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202dst : ip
15203 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15204 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15205 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15206 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015207 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15208 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15209 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15210 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15211 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15212 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213
15214dst_conn : integer
15215 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15216 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15217 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15218 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15219 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15220 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15221 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15222 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015223
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015224dst_is_local : boolean
15225 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15226 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15227 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15228 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015229 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015230 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15231 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15232 it only once per connection.
15233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015234dst_port : integer
15235 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15236 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15237 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15238 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15239 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15240 an HTTP header.
15241
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015242fc_http_major : integer
15243 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15244 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15245 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15246
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015247fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15248 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15249 header.
15250
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015251fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15252 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15253 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15254 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15255 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15256 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15257 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15258
15259fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15260 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15261 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15262 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15263 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15264 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15265 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15266
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015267fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015268 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15269 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15270 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15271 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15272
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015273fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015274 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15275 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15276 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15277 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15278
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015279fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015280 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15281 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15282 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15283 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15284
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015285fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015286 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15287 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15288 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15289 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15290
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015291fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015292 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15293 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15294 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15295 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15296
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015297fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015298 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15299 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15300 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15301 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15302
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015303fe_defbe : string
15304 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15305 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015307fe_id : integer
15308 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015309 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015310 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15311
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015312fe_name : string
15313 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15314 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15315 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15316
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015317sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015318sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15319sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15320sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015321 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15322 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15323 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15324
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015325sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015326sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15327sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15328sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015329 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15330 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15331 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15332
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015333sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015334sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15335sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15336sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015337 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15338 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015339 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15340 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15341 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015342
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015343 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015344 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15345 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015346 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15347 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15348 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015349 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15350 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15351
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015352sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15353sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15354sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15355sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15356 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15357 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15358 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15359 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15360 when a first ACL was verified.
15361
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015362sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015363sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15364sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15365sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015366 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015367 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15368
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015369sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015370sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15371sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15372sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015373 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15374 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15375 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15376
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015377sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015378sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15379sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15380sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015381 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15382 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15383 See also src_conn_rate.
15384
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015385sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015386sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15387sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15388sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015389 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015390 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015391
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015392sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15393sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15394sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15395sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15396 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15397 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15398
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015399sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15400sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15401sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15402sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15403 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15404 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15405
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015406sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015407sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15408sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15409sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015410 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15411 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15412 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015413 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15414 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15415 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015416
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015417sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15418sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15419sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15420sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15421 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15422 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15423 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15424 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15425 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15426 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15427
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015428sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015429sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15430sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15431sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015432 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015433 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15434 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15435
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015436sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015437sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15438sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15439sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015440 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15441 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15442 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15443 src_http_err_rate.
15444
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015445sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015446sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15447sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15448sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015449 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015450 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15451 src_http_req_cnt.
15452
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015453sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015454sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15455sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15456sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015457 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15458 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15459 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15460 src_http_req_rate.
15461
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015462sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015463sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15464sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15465sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015466 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015467 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15468 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15469 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15470 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015471
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015472 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015473 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15474 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015475 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15476
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015477sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15478sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15479sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15480sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15481 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15482 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15483 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15484 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15485 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15486
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015487sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015488sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15489sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15490sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015491 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15492 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15493 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015494
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015495sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015496sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15497sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15498sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015499 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15500 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15501 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015502
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015503sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015504sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15505sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15506sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015507 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015508 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15509 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15510 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015511 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015512 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15513
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015514sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015515sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15516sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15517sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015518 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15519 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15520 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15521 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15522 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015523 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015524
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015525sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015526sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15527sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15528sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015529 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15530 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15531 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15532
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015533sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015534sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15535sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15536sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015537 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15538 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015539 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015540 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15541 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015542 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15543 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15544 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546so_id : integer
15547 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15548 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15549 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015550
Jerome Magnin28b90332020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015551so_name : string
15552 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15553 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15554 strings instead of integers.
15555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015557 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15559 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15560 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015561 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15562 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15563 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015564 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15565 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15566 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15567 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15568 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15569 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15570 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015571
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015572 Example:
15573 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15574 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15577 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15578 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15579 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015580 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015582src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15583 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15584 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015585 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015586 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15589 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15590 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15591 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15592 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15593 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15594 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015595
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015596 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015597 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15598 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15599 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15600 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015601 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015602 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15603 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15604
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015605src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15606 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15607 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15608 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15609 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15610 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15611 was verified.
15612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015614 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015616 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015617 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015620 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15622 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015623 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15626 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15627 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15628 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015629 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015632 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015634 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015635 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015636
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015637src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15638 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15639 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15640 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15641 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15642
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015643src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15644 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15645 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15646 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15647 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015650 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015652 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15653 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015654 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15655 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15656 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015657
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015658src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15659 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15660 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15661 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15662 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15663 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15664 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15665 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015668 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015670 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015671 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015674src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15675 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15676 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15677 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15678 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015679 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015682 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15684 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015685 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15688 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15689 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15690 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015691 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015692 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15695 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15696 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15697 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015698 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15700 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015701
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015702 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015703 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015704 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015705 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015706
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015707src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15708 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15709 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15710 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15711 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15712 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15713 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15714
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015715src_is_local : boolean
15716 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15717 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15718 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15719 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015720 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015721 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15722 once per connection.
15723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015725 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15726 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15727 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15728 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15729 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015732 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15733 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15734 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15735 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15736 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015738src_port : integer
15739 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15740 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15741 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15742 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015745 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015746 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15747 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15748 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015749 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15752 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15753 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15754 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15755 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015756 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015758src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15759 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15760 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15761 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15762 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15763 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15764 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15765 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15766 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015767
15768 Example :
15769 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15770 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15771 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15772 listen ssh
15773 bind :22
15774 mode tcp
15775 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015776 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015777 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015778 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780srv_id : integer
15781 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15782 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15783 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015784
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157857.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015788The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15789closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15790when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15791usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015792future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015793
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001579451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15795 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15796 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15797 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15798 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15799 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15800
15801 Example :
15802 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15803 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15804 # the request.
15805 frontend http-in
15806 bind *:8081
15807 default_backend servers
15808 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15809 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15810
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015811ssl_bc : boolean
15812 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15813 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15814 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15815
15816ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15817 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15818 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15819
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015820ssl_bc_alpn : string
15821 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15822 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015823 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015824 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15825 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15826 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15827 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15828 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15829 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15830
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015831ssl_bc_cipher : string
15832 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15833 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15834
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015835ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15836 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15837 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15838 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15839
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015840ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15841 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15842 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15843 session or a TLS ticket.
15844
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015845ssl_bc_npn : string
15846 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15847 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015848 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015849 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15850 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15851 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15852 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15853 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15854
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015855ssl_bc_protocol : string
15856 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15857 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15858
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015859ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015860 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015861 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15862 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015863
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015864ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15865 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15866 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15867 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15868
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015869ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15870 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15871 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15872 if session was reused or not.
15873
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015874ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15875 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15876 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15877 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15878 BoringSSL.
15879
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015880ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15881 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15882 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015884ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15885 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15886 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15887 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15888 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15889 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15892 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15893 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15894 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15895 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015896
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015897ssl_c_der : binary
15898 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15899 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15900 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902ssl_c_err : integer
15903 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15904 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15905 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15906 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15907 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15910 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15911 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15912 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15913 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15914 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15915 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15916 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15917 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015919ssl_c_key_alg : string
15920 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15921 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15922 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015924ssl_c_notafter : string
15925 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15926 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15927 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929ssl_c_notbefore : string
15930 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15931 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15932 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15935 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15936 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15937 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15938 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15939 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15940 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15941 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15942 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944ssl_c_serial : binary
15945 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15946 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15947 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15950 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15951 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15952 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015953 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15954 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15955
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015956 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015957 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15960 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15961 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15962 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015964ssl_c_used : boolean
15965 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15966 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968ssl_c_verify : integer
15969 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15970 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15971 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15972 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974ssl_c_version : integer
15975 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15976 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015977
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015978ssl_f_der : binary
15979 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15980 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15981 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015983ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15984 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15985 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15986 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15987 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015988 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015989 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15990 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15991 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015993ssl_f_key_alg : string
15994 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15995 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15996 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015998ssl_f_notafter : string
15999 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16000 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16001 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003ssl_f_notbefore : string
16004 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16005 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16006 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016008ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
16009 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16010 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16011 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16012 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16013 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16014 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16015 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16016 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016018ssl_f_serial : binary
16019 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16020 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16021 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016022
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016023ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16024 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16025 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16026 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016028ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16029 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16030 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16031 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016033ssl_f_version : integer
16034 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16035 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16036
16037ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016038 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16039 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16040 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016042 Example :
16043 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16044 listen http-https
16045 bind :80
16046 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16047 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16048
16049ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16050 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16051 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16052
16053ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016054 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016055 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16056 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16057 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16058 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16059 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16060 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16061 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16062 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064ssl_fc_cipher : string
16065 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16066 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016067
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016068ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16069 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16070 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016071 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016072
16073ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16074 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16075 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016076 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016077
16078ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16079 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16080 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16081 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016082 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016083 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016084
16085ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16086 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16087 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016088 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016089
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016090ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16091 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16092 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16093 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016096 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16097 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016098 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16099 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16100 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16101 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016102
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016103ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16104 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16105 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16106 wait until the handshake happened.
16107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016108ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16109 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016110 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16111 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016112 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016113 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016114
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016115ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016116 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016117 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16118 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016121 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016122 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16123 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16124 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16125 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16126 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16127 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16128 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016130ssl_fc_protocol : string
16131 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16132 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016133
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016134ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016135 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016136 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16137 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016138
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016139ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16140 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16141 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16142 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016144ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16145 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16146 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16147 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16148 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016149
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016150ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16151 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16152 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16153 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16154 BoringSSL.
16155
16156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157ssl_fc_sni : string
16158 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16159 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16160 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16161 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16162 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16163
16164 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16165 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16166 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016167 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016168 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016170 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016171 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16172 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16175 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16176 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016177
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016178
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161797.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016180------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016182Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16183sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16184only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16185For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16186be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16187can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16188sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16189for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16190content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016193 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016194 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16195 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016197payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16198 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016199 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016202req.len : integer
16203req_len : integer (deprecated)
16204 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16205 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16206 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16207 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16208 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16209 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16210 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16211 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16214 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016215 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16216 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16217 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16218 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016220 ACL alternatives :
16221 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016223req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16224 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16225 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16226 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16227 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229 ACL alternatives :
16230 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016232 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016234req.proto_http : boolean
16235req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16236 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16237 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16238 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16239 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16240 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16241 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16242 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016244 Example:
16245 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16246 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16247 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016248 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16251rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16252 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16253 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16254 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16255 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16256 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16257 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16258 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016260 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16261 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16262 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16263 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16264 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16265 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267 ACL derivatives :
16268 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016270 Example :
16271 listen tse-farm
16272 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16273 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16274 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16275 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16276 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16277 persist rdp-cookie
16278 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16279 # This is only useful makes sense if
16280 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16281 stick-table type string size 204800
16282 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16283 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16284 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16287 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016289req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16290rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16291 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16292 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16293 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16294 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016296 ACL derivatives :
16297 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016298
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016299req.ssl_alpn : string
16300 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16301 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16302 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16303 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16304 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16305 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016306 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016307
16308 Examples :
16309 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16310 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16311 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016312 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016313 default_backend bk_default
16314
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016315req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16316 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16317 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016318 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16319 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16320 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16321 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16322 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016324req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16325req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16326 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16327 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16328 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16329 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16330 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16331 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16332 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016334req.ssl_sni : string
16335req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16336 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16337 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16338 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16339 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16340 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16341 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16342 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16343 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16344 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16345 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16346 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16347 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016349 ACL derivatives :
16350 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016352 Examples :
16353 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16354 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16355 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16356 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16357 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016358
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016359req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16360 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16361 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16362 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16363 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16364 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16365 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16366 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16367 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16368 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016370req.ssl_ver : integer
16371req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16372 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16373 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16374 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16375 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16376 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16377 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16378 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016379 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016380 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016382 ACL derivatives :
16383 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016384
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016385res.len : integer
16386 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16387 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16388 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16389 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16390 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16391 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16392 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16393 content inspection.
16394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016395res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16396 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016397 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16398 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16399 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16400 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016402res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16403 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16404 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16405 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16406 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016408 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016409
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016410res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16411rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16412 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16413 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16414 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16415 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16416 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16417 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16418 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016420wait_end : boolean
16421 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16422 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016423 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016424 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16425 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016426 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016427 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16428 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016430 Examples :
16431 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16432 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16433 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016435 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16436 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16437 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16438 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16439 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16440 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16441 tcp-request content reject
16442
16443
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164447.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016445--------------------------------------
16446
16447It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16448This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16449data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16450its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16451HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16452content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16453to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16454more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16455response are indexed.
16456
16457base : string
16458 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16459 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16460 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16461 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16462 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16463 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16464 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16465 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16466
16467 ACL derivatives :
16468 base : exact string match
16469 base_beg : prefix match
16470 base_dir : subdir match
16471 base_dom : domain match
16472 base_end : suffix match
16473 base_len : length match
16474 base_reg : regex match
16475 base_sub : substring match
16476
16477base32 : integer
16478 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16479 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16480 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016481 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16482 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16483 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016484
16485base32+src : binary
16486 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16487 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16488 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16489 per-URL counters.
16490
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016491capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16492 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16493 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16494 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16495
16496capture.req.method : string
16497 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16498 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16499 because it's allocated.
16500
16501capture.req.uri : string
16502 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16503 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16504 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16505 allocated.
16506
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016507capture.req.ver : string
16508 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16509 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16510 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16511
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016512capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16513 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16514 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16515 The first entry is an index of 0.
16516 See also: "capture response header"
16517
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016518capture.res.ver : string
16519 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16520 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16521 persistent flag.
16522
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016523req.body : binary
16524 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16525 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16526 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16527 the first chunk is analyzed.
16528
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016529req.body_param([<name>) : string
16530 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16531 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16532 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16533 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16534 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16535 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16536 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16537 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16538 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16539 given.
16540
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016541req.body_len : integer
16542 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16543 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16544 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16545 "option http-buffer-request".
16546
16547req.body_size : integer
16548 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16549 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16550 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16551 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16552 "option http-buffer-request".
16553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016554req.cook([<name>]) : string
16555cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16556 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16557 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16558 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16559 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16560 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16561 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16562 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16563 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16564
16565 ACL derivatives :
16566 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16567 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16568 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16569 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16570 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16571 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16572 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16573 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016575req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16576cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16577 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16578 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016580req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16581cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16582 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16583 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16584 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16585 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016587cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16588 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16589 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16590 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16591 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016592 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16594 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16595 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16596 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016598hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16599 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16600 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16601 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16602 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016603 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016605req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16606 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16607 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16608 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16609 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16610 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16611 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16612 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16613 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016615req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16616 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16617 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16618 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16619 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016621req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16622 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16623 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16624 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16625 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16626 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16627 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16628 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16629 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016630 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016631 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016632 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016634 ACL derivatives :
16635 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16636 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16637 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16638 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16639 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16640 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16641 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16642 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16643
16644req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16645hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16646 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16647 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16648 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16649 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16650 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16651 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16652 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16653 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16654 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16655
16656req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16657hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16658 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16659 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16660 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreaud08feaf2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010016661 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
16662 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
16663 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
16664 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
16665 cause the address to be ignored. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016666 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016667 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016668 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16669 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16670
16671req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16672hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16673 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16674 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16675 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16676 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16677 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16678 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16679 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16680
Christopher Faulet5be59a92020-11-24 17:13:24 +010016681req.hdrs : string
16682 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16683 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16684 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16685 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16686
16687req.hdrs_bin : binary
16688 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16689 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16690 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16691 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16692 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16693 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16694
16695 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016696
Christopher Faulet5be59a92020-11-24 17:13:24 +010016697 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16698 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016700http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16701 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16702 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16703 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16704 basic auth is supported.
16705
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016706http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16707 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16708 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16709 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16710 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016711 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16712 basic auth is supported.
16713
16714 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016715 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16716 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16717 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16718 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016719
16720http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016721 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16722 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016723 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16724 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016726method : integer + string
16727 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16728 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16729 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16730 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16731 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16732 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16733 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016735 ACL derivatives :
16736 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016738 Example :
16739 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16740 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16741 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016743path : string
16744 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16745 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16746 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16747 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16748 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016749 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016750 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016752 ACL derivatives :
16753 path : exact string match
16754 path_beg : prefix match
16755 path_dir : subdir match
16756 path_dom : domain match
16757 path_end : suffix match
16758 path_len : length match
16759 path_reg : regex match
16760 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016761
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016762query : string
16763 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16764 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16765 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16766 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016767 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016768 which stops before the question mark.
16769
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016770req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16771 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16772 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16773 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16774 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776req.ver : string
16777req_ver : string (deprecated)
16778 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16779 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16780 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016782 ACL derivatives :
16783 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016785res.comp : boolean
16786 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16787 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16788 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016790res.comp_algo : string
16791 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16792 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16793 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016795res.cook([<name>]) : string
16796scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16797 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16798 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16799 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801 ACL derivatives :
16802 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016804res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16805scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16806 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16807 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16808 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016810res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16811scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16812 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16813 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16814 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016816res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16817 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16818 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16819 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16820 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16821 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16822 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16823 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16824 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16825 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016827res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16828 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16829 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16830 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16831 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16832 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016834res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16835shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16836 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16837 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16838 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16839 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16840 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16841 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16842 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16843 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016845 ACL derivatives :
16846 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16847 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16848 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16849 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16850 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16851 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16852 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16853 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16854
16855res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16856shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16857 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16858 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16859 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16860 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16861 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016863res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16864shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16865 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16866 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16867 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16868 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16869 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16870 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016871
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016872res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16873 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16874 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16875 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16876 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016878res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16879shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16880 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16881 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16882 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16883 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16884 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16885 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016887res.ver : string
16888resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16889 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16890 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016892 ACL derivatives :
16893 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016895set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16896 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16897 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016898 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016899 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016901 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16902 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016904status : integer
16905 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16906 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16907 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016908
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016909unique-id : string
16910 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16911 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16912 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16913 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16914 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16915 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016917url : string
16918 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16919 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16920 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16921 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16922 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16923 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16924 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016926 ACL derivatives :
16927 url : exact string match
16928 url_beg : prefix match
16929 url_dir : subdir match
16930 url_dom : domain match
16931 url_end : suffix match
16932 url_len : length match
16933 url_reg : regex match
16934 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016936url_ip : ip
16937 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16938 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16939 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16940 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16941 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16942 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16943 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016945url_port : integer
16946 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16947 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16948 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16949 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016950
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016951urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16952url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016953 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16954 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016955 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16956 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16957 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16958 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016959 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16960 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016961 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16962 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016964 ACL derivatives :
16965 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16966 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16967 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16968 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16969 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16970 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16971 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16972 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016973
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016975 Example :
16976 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16977 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16978 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16979 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016980
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016981urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016982 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16983 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16984 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016985
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016986url32 : integer
16987 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16988 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16989 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16990 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16991 is an unsigned integer.
16992
16993url32+src : binary
16994 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16995 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16996 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16997
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169997.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017000---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017002Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17003every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017004order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017006ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17007---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017008FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017009HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017010HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17011HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017012HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17013HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17014HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17015HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17016LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017017METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017018METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017019METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17020METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17021METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17022METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017023METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017024METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017025RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017026REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017027TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017028WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17029---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017030
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170328. Logging
17033----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017034
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017035One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17036provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17037very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17038provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17039state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017040to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017041headers.
17042
17043In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17044about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17045send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17046
17047 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17048 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17049 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17050 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17051 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017052 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017053 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017054
17055The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17056allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17057as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17058while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17059real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17060delay.
17061
17062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170638.1. Log levels
17064---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017065
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017066TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017067source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017068HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17069in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17070track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17071syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17072about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017073
17074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170758.2. Log formats
17076----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017077
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017078HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017079and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17080slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17081options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017082
17083 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17084 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17085 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17086 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17087 extents.
17088
17089 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17090 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17091 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17092 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17093 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17094
17095 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17096 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17097 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17098 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17099 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17100
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017101 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17102 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17103 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17104 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17105
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017106 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17107
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017108Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17109specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17110field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17111servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17112always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17113identifier.
17114
17115Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17116 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17117 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17118 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17119 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17120
17121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171228.2.1. Default log format
17123-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017124
17125This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17126as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17127format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17128
17129 Example :
17130 listen www
17131 mode http
17132 log global
17133 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17134
17135 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17136 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17137 (www/HTTP)
17138
17139 Field Format Extract from the example above
17140 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17141 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17142 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17143 4 'to' to
17144 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17145 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17146
17147Detailed fields description :
17148 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17149 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17150 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17151 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17152 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17153 and processed the connection.
17154 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17155
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017156In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17157"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17158connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17159
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017160It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17161will eventually disappear.
17162
17163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171648.2.2. TCP log format
17165---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017166
17167The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17168is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17169information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17170counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17171emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17172environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17173the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17174sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017175specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17176not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17177fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17178marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017179
17180 Example :
17181 frontend fnt
17182 mode tcp
17183 option tcplog
17184 log global
17185 default_backend bck
17186
17187 backend bck
17188 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17189
17190 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17191 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17192 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17193
17194 Field Format Extract from the example above
17195 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17196 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17197 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17198 4 frontend_name fnt
17199 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17200 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17201 7 bytes_read* 212
17202 8 termination_state --
17203 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17204 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17205
17206Detailed fields description :
17207 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017208 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17209 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17210 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017211 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017212 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017213 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017214
17215 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017216 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17217 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17218 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017219
17220 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17221 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17222 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017223 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17224 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17225 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17226 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017227
17228 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17229 and processed the connection.
17230
17231 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17232 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17233 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17234 applications.
17235
17236 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17237 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17238 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17239 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17240 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17241
17242 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17243 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17244 See "Timers" below for more details.
17245
17246 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17247 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17248 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17249 "Timers" below for more details.
17250
17251 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017252 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017253 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17254 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17255 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17256 details.
17257
17258 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17259 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17260 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17261 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17262 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17263
17264 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17265 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17266 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17267 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17268 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17269 for more details.
17270
17271 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017272 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017273 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17274 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17275 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017276 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017277
17278 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17279 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17280 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17281 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17282 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17283 caused by a denial of service attack.
17284
17285 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17286 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17287 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17288 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17289 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17290 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17291 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17292 denial of service attack.
17293
17294 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17295 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17296 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17297 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17298 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17299 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17300 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17301 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17302 be processed than on other servers.
17303
17304 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17305 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17306 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17307 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17308 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17309 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17310 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17311 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17312 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17313 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17314 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17315 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17316 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17317
17318 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17319 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17320 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17321 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17322 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17323 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017324 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017325 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17326
17327 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17328 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17329 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17330 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17331 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17332 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017333 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017334 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17335 occurs.
17336
17337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173388.2.3. HTTP log format
17339----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017340
17341The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17342is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17343the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17344are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17345emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17346generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17347"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17348which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017349frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17350is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017351
17352Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17353slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17354with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17355
17356 Example :
17357 frontend http-in
17358 mode http
17359 option httplog
17360 log global
17361 default_backend bck
17362
17363 backend static
17364 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17365
17366 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17367 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17368 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017369 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017370
17371 Field Format Extract from the example above
17372 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17373 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017374 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017375 4 frontend_name http-in
17376 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017377 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017378 7 status_code 200
17379 8 bytes_read* 2750
17380 9 captured_request_cookie -
17381 10 captured_response_cookie -
17382 11 termination_state ----
17383 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17384 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17385 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17386 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17387 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017388
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017389Detailed fields description :
17390 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017391 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17392 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17393 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017394 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017395 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017396 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017397
17398 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017399 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17400 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17401 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017402
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017403 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17404 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017405
17406 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17407 and processed the connection.
17408
17409 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17410 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17411 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17412
17413 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17414 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17415 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17416 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17417 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17418 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17419
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017420 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17421 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17422 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017423 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017424 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17425 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017426 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17427 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017428
17429 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17430 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017431 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017432
17433 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17434 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017435 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17436 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017437
17438 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17439 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17440 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17441 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17442 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017443 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17444 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017445
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017446 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17447 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17448 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17449 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17450 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17451 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17452 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017453 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017454
17455 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17456 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17457 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17458
17459 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17460 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017461 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017462 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17463 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17464 overflowing.
17465
17466 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17467 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17468 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17469 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17470 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17471 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17472 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17473 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17474
17475 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17476 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17477 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17478 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17479 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17480 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17481 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17482 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17483
17484 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17485 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17486 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17487 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17488 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17489 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17490 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17491
17492 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017493 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017494 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17495 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17496 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017497 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017498 system.
17499
17500 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17501 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17502 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17503 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17504 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17505 caused by a denial of service attack.
17506
17507 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17508 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17509 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17510 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17511 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17512 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17513 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17514 denial of service attack.
17515
17516 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17517 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17518 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17519 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17520 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17521 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17522 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17523 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17524 processed than on other servers.
17525
17526 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17527 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17528 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17529 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17530 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17531 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17532 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17533 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17534 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17535 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17536 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17537 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17538 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17539
17540 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17541 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17542 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17543 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17544 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17545 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017546 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017547 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17548
17549 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17550 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17551 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17552 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17553 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17554 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017555 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017556 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17557 occurs.
17558
17559 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17560 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17561 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17562 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17563 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17564 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17565 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17566 cookies" below for more details.
17567
17568 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17569 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17570 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17571 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17572 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17573 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17574 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17575 and cookies" below for more details.
17576
17577 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17578 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17579 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17580 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17581 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17582 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17583 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17584 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17585
17586
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200175878.2.4. Custom log format
17588------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017589
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017590The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017591mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017592
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017593HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017594Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17595separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17596prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17597
17598Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17599variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017600("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017601
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017602If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017603as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017604less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17605the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17606
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017607Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017608In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017609in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017610
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017611Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17612'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17613https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17614such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17615
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017616Flags are :
17617 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017618 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017619 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17620 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017621
17622 Example:
17623
17624 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17625 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17626
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017627 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17628
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017629At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17630
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017631 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17632 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017633
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017634the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017635
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017636 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17637 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17638 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017639
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017640and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17641
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017642 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17643 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017644
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017645Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17646
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017647 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017648 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017649 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17650 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17651 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017652 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17653 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17654 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017655 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017656 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17657 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017658 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017659 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17660 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017661 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017662 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017663 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017664 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017665 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017666 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017667 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017668 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17669 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17670 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17671 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17672 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017673 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017674 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17675 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017676 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017677 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17678 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017679 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17680 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17681 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017682 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017683 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17684 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017685 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017686 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17687 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17688 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017689 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017690 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017691 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17692 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17693 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17694 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017695 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017696 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017697 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017698 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017699 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017700 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017701 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17702 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17703 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017704 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017705 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17706 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017707 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017708 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17709 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017710 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017711 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017712 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017713 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017714
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017715 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017716
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017717
177188.2.5. Error log format
17719-----------------------
17720
17721When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17722protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17723By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17724"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017725will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017726logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17727
17728The format looks like this :
17729
17730 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17731 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17732 Connection error during SSL handshake
17733
17734 Field Format Extract from the example above
17735 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17736 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17737 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17738 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17739 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17740
17741These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17742failures.
17743
17744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177458.3. Advanced logging options
17746-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017747
17748Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17749just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17750options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17751for more information about their usage.
17752
17753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177548.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17755------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017756
17757It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17758haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17759commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17760monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17761ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17762
17763 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17764 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17765 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17766 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17767
17768 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17769 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17770 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017771 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017772 such as other load-balancers.
17773
17774 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17775 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17776 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17777
17778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177798.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17780----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017781
17782The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17783what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17784or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017785"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017786just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17787log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17788after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17789is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17790with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17791with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17792
17793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177948.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17795------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017796
17797Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17798for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17799"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17800retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17801raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17802a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17803file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17804you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17805"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17806
17807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17809--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017810
17811Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17812multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17813them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17814"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17815logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17816error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17817and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17818too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17819useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17820alternative.
17821
17822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178238.4. Timing events
17824------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017825
17826Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17827reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17828the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17829frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017830mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17831addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17832
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017833Timings events in HTTP mode:
17834
17835 first request 2nd request
17836 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17837 t tr t tr ...
17838 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17839 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17840 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17841 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17842 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17843
17844Timings events in TCP mode:
17845
17846 TCP session
17847 |<----------------->|
17848 t t
17849 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17850 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17851 |<------ Tt ------->|
17852
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017853 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017854 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017855 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17856 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17857 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017858 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017859 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17860 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17861 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17862 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017863
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017864 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17865 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17866 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017867 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17868 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17869 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17870 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17871 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17872 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017873
17874 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17875 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17876 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17877 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17878 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17879 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17880 request typed by hand during a test.
17881
17882 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17883 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017884 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017885 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17886 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17887 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17888 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017889
17890 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17891 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17892 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17893 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17894 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17895
17896 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17897 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17898 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17899 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17900 connection never established.
17901
17902 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17903 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17904 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17905 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17906 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17907 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17908 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17909 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17910 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17911 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17912 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17913
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017914 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17915 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17916 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17917 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17918 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17919 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17920
17921 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17922
17923 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17924 "Ta" can never be negative.
17925
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017926 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17927 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017928 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17929 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017930 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017931
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017932 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017933
17934 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017935 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17936 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017937
17938These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17939protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17940that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017941due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17942"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17943that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017944
17945Most common cases :
17946
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017947 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17948 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17949 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17950 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17951 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17952 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17953 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17954 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17955 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17956 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17957 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017958 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017959
17960 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17961 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17962 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17963 of ms on remote networks.
17964
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017965 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17966 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17967 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017968
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017969 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17970 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17971 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17972 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17973 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17974 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17975 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17976 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17977 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017978
17979Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17980
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017981 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017982 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017983 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017984
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017985 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017986 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17987 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17988
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017989 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017990 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17991 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17992 flags.
17993
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017994 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17995 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017996 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17997 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17998 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17999 the client connection was maintained open.
18000
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018001 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018002 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018003 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018004 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18005
18006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180078.5. Session state at disconnection
18008-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018009
18010TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18011"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
180122-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18013each of which has a special meaning :
18014
18015 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18016 session to terminate :
18017
18018 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18019
18020 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18021 server explicitly refused it.
18022
18023 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18024 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18025 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18026 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018027 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018028
18029 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18030 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018031
18032 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18033 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18034 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18035 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18036 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18037
18038 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18039 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18040 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18041 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18042 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18043
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018044 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18045 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18046
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018047 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18048 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18049 backup connections when going up.
18050
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018051 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18052
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018053 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18054 send or receive data.
18055
18056 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18057 send or receive data.
18058
18059 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18060 with nothing left in the buffers.
18061
18062 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18063
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018064 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018065 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18066
18067 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18068 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18069 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18070 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18071 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18072
18073 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18074 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18075
18076 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18077 server (HTTP only).
18078
18079 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18080
18081 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18082 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18083 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18084
18085 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18086 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18087 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18088
18089 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18090
18091 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18092 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18093
18094 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18095 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18096 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18097
18098 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18099 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018100 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18101 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018102
18103 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18104 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18105 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18106 another server.
18107
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018108 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018109 server.
18110
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018111 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18112 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18113 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18114 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18115
18116 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18117 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18118 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18119 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18120
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018121 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18122 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18123 "use-server" rule).
18124
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018125 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18126
18127 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18128 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18129
18130 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18131
18132 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18133 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18134 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18135
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018136 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18137 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018138 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018139 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18140 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18141
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018142 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18143
18144 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18145 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18146
18147 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18148
18149 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18150
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018151The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18152was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018153helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18154starvation, attacks, etc...
18155
18156The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18157alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18158easier finding and understanding.
18159
18160 Flags Reason
18161
18162 -- Normal termination.
18163
18164 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18165 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18166 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18167 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18168
18169 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18170 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18171 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18172 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18173 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18174 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018175
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018176 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18177 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018178 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018179
18180 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18181 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18182 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18183
18184 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18185 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18186 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18187 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18188 the server takes too long to respond.
18189
18190 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18191 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18192 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18193 long a time to respond.
18194
18195 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18196 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18197 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18198 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018199 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18200 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018201
18202 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18203 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18204 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18205 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18206 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018207 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018208 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18209 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18210 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18211 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18212 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18213 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18214 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18215 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018216 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018217 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18218 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18219 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018220
18221 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18222 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018223 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18224 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18225 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18226 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018227
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018228 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18229 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018231 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018232 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18233 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018234 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018235 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18236 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18237
18238 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18239 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18240 503 or 504 here.
18241
18242 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18243 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18244 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18245 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18246 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18247
18248 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18249 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018250 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018251 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18252 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18253
18254 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18255 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18256 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18257 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18258 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18259 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18260 between haproxy and the server.
18261
18262 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18263 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18264 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18265 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18266 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18267 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18268 solution is to fix the application.
18269
18270 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18271 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18272 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18273 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18274 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18275 external attacks.
18276
18277 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070018278 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018279 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018280 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18281 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18282
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018283 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18284 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18285 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018286 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018287 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018288
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018289 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18290 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18291 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18292 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018293 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18294 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18295 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18296 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18297 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018298
18299 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18300 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18301 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18302 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18303
18304 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18305 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18306 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18307 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18308
18309 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18310 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18311 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18312 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18313
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018314The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18315persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18316important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18317re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18318
18319 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18320
18321 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18322 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18323 set on a GET request.
18324
18325 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18326 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018327 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018328 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18329
18330 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18331 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18332 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18333
18334 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18335 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18336 already got a cookie.
18337
18338 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18339 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18340 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18341 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18342 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18343
18344 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18345 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18346 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18347
18348 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18349 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18350 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18351
18352 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18353 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18354
18355 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18356 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18357 then advertised in the response.
18358
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183608.6. Non-printable characters
18361-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018362
18363In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18364consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18365converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18366prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18367being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18368escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18369is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18370'}' when logging headers.
18371
18372Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18373issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18374containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18375
18376Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18377the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18378performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18379
18380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183818.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18382---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018383
18384Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18385achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018386section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018387cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18388the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18389the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018390locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018391not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18392user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18393a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18394wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18395
18396 Examples :
18397 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18398 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18399
18400 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18401 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18402
18403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18405---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018406
18407Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18408proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18409the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18410server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18411
18412Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18413response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018414section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018415
18416It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018417time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18418appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018419are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18420and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18421follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18422request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18423in the logs.
18424
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018425As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18426frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18427an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18428
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018429 Example :
18430 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18431 listen proxy-out
18432 mode http
18433 option httplog
18434 option logasap
18435 log global
18436 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18437
18438 # log the name of the virtual server
18439 capture request header Host len 20
18440
18441 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18442 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18443
18444 # log the beginning of the referrer
18445 capture request header Referer len 20
18446
18447 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18448 capture response header Server len 20
18449
18450 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18451 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18452
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018453 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018454 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18455
18456 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18457 capture response header Via len 20
18458
18459 # log the URL location during a redirection
18460 capture response header Location len 20
18461
18462 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18463 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18464 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18465 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18466 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18467
18468 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18469 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18470 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18471 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018472 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018473
18474 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18475 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18476 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18477 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18478 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018479 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018480
18481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184828.9. Examples of logs
18483---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018484
18485These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18486them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18487reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18488
18489 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18490 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18491 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18492
18493 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18494 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18495
18496 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18497 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18498 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18499
18500 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18501 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18502
18503 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18504 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18505 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18506
18507 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018508 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018509 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18510 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18511
18512 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18513 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18514 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18515
18516 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18517 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018518 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018519 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18520 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18521 to return the 502 and not the server.
18522
18523 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018524 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018525
18526 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18527 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18528 Nothing was sent to any server.
18529
18530 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18531 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18532
18533 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18534 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018535 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018536 send a 408 return code to the client.
18537
18538 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18539 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18540
18541 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18542 5 seconds ("c----").
18543
18544 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18545 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018546 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018547
18548 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018549 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018550 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18551 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18552 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18553 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18554 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018555
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018556
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200185579. Supported filters
18558--------------------
18559
18560Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18561accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18562unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18563
18564See also : "filter"
18565
185669.1. Trace
18567----------
18568
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018569filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018570
18571 Arguments:
18572 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18573 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18574
18575 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18576 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18577 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18578 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18579
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018580 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018581 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18582 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18583 amount of the parsed data.
18584
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018585 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018586
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018587This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18588callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18589information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18590filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18591
18592Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18593tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18594a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18595
18596
185979.2. HTTP compression
18598---------------------
18599
18600filter compression
18601
18602The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18603keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018604when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18605it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18606response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18607line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18608cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18609the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018610
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018611See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018612
18613
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200186149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18615--------------------------------------------
18616
18617filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18618
18619 Arguments :
18620
18621 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18622 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18623 parsed.
18624
18625 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18626 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18627 part must be placed in its own scope.
18628
18629The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18630external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018631streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018632exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18633also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18634
18635SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18636the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18637
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018638For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018639"doc/SPOE.txt".
18640
18641Important note:
18642 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18643 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18644
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100186459.4. Cache
18646----------
18647
18648filter cache <name>
18649
18650 Arguments :
18651
18652 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18653
18654The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18655"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018656cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018657other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18658the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18659mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18660filter other than the compression is used for the same
18661listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18662order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018663
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018664See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018665
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001866610. Cache
18667---------
18668
18669HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18670(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18671RAM.
18672
18673The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018674this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018675
18676If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18677independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18678when we try to allocate a new one.
18679
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018680The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018681
18682It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18683"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18684for more details.
18685
18686When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18687replaced by "<CACHE>".
18688
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001868910.1. Limitation
18690----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018691
18692The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18693
18694- If the response is not a 200
18695- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018696- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018697- If the response is not cacheable
18698
18699- If the request is not a GET
18700- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018701- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018702
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018703Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18704filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18705can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18706example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18707"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018708
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001870910.2. Setup
18710-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018711
18712To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18713the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18714
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001871510.2.1. Cache section
18716---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018717
18718cache <name>
18719 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18720 size of cache is mandatory.
18721
18722total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018723 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018724 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018725
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018726max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018727 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18728 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18729 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018730
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018731max-age <seconds>
18732 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18733 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18734 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18735 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18736 default.
18737
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001873810.2.2. Proxy section
18739---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018740
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018741http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018742 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18743 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18744 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18745 after this one.
18746
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018747http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018748 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18749 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18750 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18751 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18752
18753
18754Example:
18755
18756 backend bck1
18757 mode http
18758
18759 http-request cache-use foobar
18760 http-response cache-store foobar
18761 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18762
18763 cache foobar
18764 total-max-size 4
18765 max-age 240
18766
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018767/*
18768 * Local variables:
18769 * fill-column: 79
18770 * End:
18771 */